blob: 80a90fb2537265eb33d0ee6b18d7ca17976cf49f [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Fauletec554342022-09-28 14:51:49 +02006 2022/09/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100968 - 51degrees-cache-size
969 - 51degrees-data-file
970 - 51degrees-property-name-list
971 - 51degrees-property-separator
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200972 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200973 - chroot
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100975 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200977 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200978 - description
979 - deviceatlas-json-file
980 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200981 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100982 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200983 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900984 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985 - gid
986 - group
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200987 - h1-case-adjust
988 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
990 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100991 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100992 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100993 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200994 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100996 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100997 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200998 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100999 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001000 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001001 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001003 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001004 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001005 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001007 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001008 - presetenv
1009 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001010 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001011 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001012 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001023 - stats
1024 - strict-limits
1025 - uid
1026 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001027 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001028 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001029 - user
1030 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001031 - wurfl-data-file
1032 - wurfl-information-list
1033 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001038 - maxcompcpuusage
1039 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001041 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001049 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001050 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001051 - nokqueue
1052 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001053 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001054 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001056 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001058 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001077 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001078 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1079 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001095 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
1096 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
1097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001098 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001099 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1100 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001101 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100111851degrees-data-file <file path>
1119 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1120 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1121
1122 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1123 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1124
112551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1126 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1127 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1128 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1129
1130 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1131 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1132
113351degrees-property-separator <char>
1134 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1135 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1136
1137 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1138 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1139
114051degrees-cache-size <number>
1141 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1142 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1143 By default, this cache is disabled.
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
1146 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1147
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148ca-base <dir>
1149 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001150 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1151 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1152 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001154chroot <jail dir>
1155 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1156 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1157 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1158 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1159 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001161
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1163 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1164 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1165 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1166 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1167 set. These sets have the format
1168
1169 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1170
1171 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001172 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001173 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1174 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001175 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1176 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001177 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1178 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1179 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1180 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1181 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1182 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1183 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1184 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1185 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1186 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001187
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001188 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1189 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1190 on the machine's word size.
1191
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001192 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001193 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1194 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1195 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1196 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1197 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1198 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001199
1200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1202
1203 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1204 # first 4 CPUs
1205
1206 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1207 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1208 # word size.
1209
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001210 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001211 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001212 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1213 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1214 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1215
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001216 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1217 # and so on.
1218 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1219 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1221
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001222 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001223 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1224 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1225 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1226
1227 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1228 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1229 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1230
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001231 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1232 # and a thread range.
1233 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1234 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1235 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1236
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001237crt-base <dir>
1238 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001239 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1240 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001241
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001242daemon
1243 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1244 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001245 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1246 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001247
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001248default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001249 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001250 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1251 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1252 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1253 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1254 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1255 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1256 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1257 not start with a slash ('/'):
1258 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1259 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1260
1261 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1262 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1263 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1264 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1265 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1266 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1267 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1268 each of them.
1269
1270 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1271 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1272 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1273 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1274 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1275 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1276 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1277 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1278
1279 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1280 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001281 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001282 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1283 made easily relocatable.
1284
1285 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1286 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1287 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1288 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1289 consistent across all configuration files.
1290
1291 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1292 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1293 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1294 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1295 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1296 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1297 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1298 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1299
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001300description <text>
1301 Add a text that describes the instance.
1302
1303 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1304 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1305 "<" and ">" characters.
1306
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001307deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1308 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001309 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001310
1311deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001312 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001313 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1314
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001315deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001316 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1317 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1318 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001319
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001320deviceatlas-separator <char>
1321 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1322 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1323
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001324expose-experimental-directives
1325 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1326 the config file will be rejected.
1327
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001328external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001329 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1330 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001331 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1332 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1333 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1334 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1335 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001337gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001338 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001339 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1340 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001341 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001342 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001343 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001344
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001345group <group name>
1346 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1347 See also "gid" and "user".
1348
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001349h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1350 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1351 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1352 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1353 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001354 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001355 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1356 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1357 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1358 specified in a proxy.
1359
1360 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1361 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1362 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1363 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1364 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1365 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1366 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1367
1368 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1369 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1370 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1371 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1372 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1373
1374 Example:
1375 global
1376 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1377
1378 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1379 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1380
1381h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1382 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1383 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1384 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1385 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1386 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1387 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1388 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1389 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1390
1391 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1392 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1393 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1394
1395 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1396 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1397
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001398h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1399 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1400 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1401 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1402 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1403 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1404 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1405 the keyword with "no'.
1406
1407hard-stop-after <time>
1408 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1409
1410 Arguments :
1411 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1412 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1413 SIGUSR1 signal.
1414
1415 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1416 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1417 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1418
1419 Example:
1420 global
1421 hard-stop-after 30s
1422
1423 See also: grace
1424
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001425insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001426 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001427 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1428 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1429 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1430 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1431 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1432 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1433 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001434 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001435 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1436 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1437 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1438 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1439 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1440 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1441 disable it.
1442
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001443insecure-setuid-wanted
1444 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1445 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1446 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1447 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001448 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001449 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001451 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1452 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001453 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001454 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1455 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1456 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1457 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1458
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001459issuers-chain-path <dir>
1460 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1461 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1462 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001463 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001464 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1465 "issuers-chain-path".
1466 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1467 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1468 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1469 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1470 will share the chain in memory.
1471
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001472localpeer <name>
1473 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1474 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1475 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1476 the configuration parsing.
1477
1478 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1479 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1480
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001481log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001482 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001483 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001485 configured with "log global".
1486
1487 <address> can be one of:
1488
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001489 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001490 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1491 port).
1492
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001493 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1494 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1495 port).
1496
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001497 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001498 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1499 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001500 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001501
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001502 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1503 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1504 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1505 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1506 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1507 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1508 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1509 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1510 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1511 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001512 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001513 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1514 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1515 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001516 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1517 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001518
1519 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1520 "fd@2", see above.
1521
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001522 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1523 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1524 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1525 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1526 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1527
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001528 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1529 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001530
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001531 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1532 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1533 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1534 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1535 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1536 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1537 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1538 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1539 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1540 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1542 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001543
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001544 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1545 one of the following :
1546
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001547 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1548 field is stripped. This is the default.
1549 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1550 rfc3164.
1551
1552 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001553 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1554
1555 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1556 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1557
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001558 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1559 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1560 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1561 designed to be used with a local log server.
1562
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001563 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1564 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1565 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1566 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1567 logger consumes.
1568
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001569 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1570 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1571 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1572 used with a local log server.
1573
1574 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1575 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1576 designed to be used with a local log server.
1577
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001578 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1579 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1580 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1581 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1582
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001583 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1584 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1585 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1586 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1587 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1588
1589 <sample_size>
1590 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1591 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1592 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1593 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1594 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1595
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001596 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001597
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001598 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1599 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1600 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1601
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001602 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1603 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1604 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1605 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606
1607 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001608 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1609 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1610 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1611 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1612 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1613 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001614
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001615 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001617log-send-hostname [<string>]
1618 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1619 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1620 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1621 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1622 the logs.
1623
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001624log-tag <string>
1625 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1626 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1627 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001628 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001629
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001630lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001631 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1632 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1633 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1634 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1635 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1636 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001637 used multiple times.
1638
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001639lua-load-per-thread <file>
1640 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1641 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1642 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1643 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1644 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1645 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1646 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1647 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1648 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1649 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1650 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1651 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1652 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1653 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1654 times.
1655
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001656lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1657 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1658 variable.
1659 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1660 to "path".
1661
1662 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1663 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1664 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1665 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1666 will be checked earlier.
1667
1668 As an example by specifying the following path:
1669
1670 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1671 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1672
1673 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1674 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1675 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1676 paths if that does not exist either.
1677
1678 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1679 documentation.
1680
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001681master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001682 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1683 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1684 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001685 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001686 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1687 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001688 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1689 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1690 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1691 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1692 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001693
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001694 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001695
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001696mworker-max-reloads <number>
1697 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001698 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001699 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1700 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1701 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1702
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001703nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001704 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1705 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1706 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001707 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1708 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001709 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1710 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1711 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001713nbthread <number>
1714 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001716 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1717 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1718 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1719 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001720 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1721 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1722 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1723 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1724 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1725 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1726 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001727
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001728numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001729 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001730 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1731 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1732 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1733 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1734 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1735 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1736 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1737 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1738
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001739pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001740 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1741 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1742 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1743 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001744
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001745pp2-never-send-local
1746 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1747 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1748 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1749 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1750 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1751 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1752 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1753 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1754 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1755 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1756 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1757
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001758presetenv <name> <value>
1759 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1760 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1761 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1762 and "unsetenv".
1763
1764resetenv [<name> ...]
1765 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1766 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1767 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1768 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1769 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1770 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1771 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1772 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1773
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001774stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001775 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1776 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1777 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1778 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1779 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1780 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001781 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001782 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1783 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1784 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1785 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001786
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001787server-state-base <directory>
1788 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001789 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1790 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001791
1792server-state-file <file>
1793 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1794 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1795 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1796 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1797 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1798 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1799 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1800 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001801 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1802 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001803
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001804set-dumpable
1805 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1806 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1807 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1808 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1809 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1810 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1811 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1812 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1813 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1814 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1815 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1816 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1817 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1818 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1819 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1820 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1821 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
1822 leaves a core where expected when dying.
1823
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001824set-var <var-name> <expr>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1826 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1829 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1830 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1831 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1832 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1833 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834
1835 Example:
1836 global
1837 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1838 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1839 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1849 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1856 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1857 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001858
1859ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1860 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1861 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1862 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1863 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1864 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001865 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1866 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1867 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001868 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001869
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001870ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1871 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1872 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1873 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1874 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1875 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1876
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001877ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1878 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1879 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1880 keyword to see available options.
1881
1882 Example:
1883 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001884 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001885
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001886ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1887 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1888 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001889 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001890 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001891 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1892 information and recommendations see e.g.
1893 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1894 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1895 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1896 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1897 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001898
1899ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1900 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1901 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1902 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1903 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1904 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001905 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1906 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1907 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1908 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1913 keyword to see available options.
1914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001919 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1928
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001929ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1930 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1931 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001932 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001933 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001934 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1935
1936 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001937
1938 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1939 and won't try to remove them.
1940
1941 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1942
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001943ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001944 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001945 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1946 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1947 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948
1949 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1950 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1951 optimize the startup time.
1952
1953 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1954 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1955 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1956
1957 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001958 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001959
1960 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001961 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1962 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001963
1964 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1965 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1966 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1967 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1968 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001969 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001970
1971 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001972 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001973 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1974 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1975 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1976 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1977 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001978 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001979
1980 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001982 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983 a cert bundle.
1984
1985 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1986 separately in several "crt".
1987
1988 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1989 since files are loading separately.
1990
1991 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1992 required to commit them.
1993
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001994 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001995 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001996
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001997 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1998 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1999 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002000
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002001 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2002 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2003 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002004
2005 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002006 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2007 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002008
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002009 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2010 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2011
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002012 The default behavior is "all".
2013
2014 Example:
2015 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2016 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2017 ssl-load-extra-files none
2018
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002019 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2020 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002021
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002022ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2023 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2024 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2025 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2026
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002027ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002028 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002029 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2030 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2031 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2032 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2033 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2034 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002035 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002036
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002037stats maxconn <connections>
2038 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2039 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2040
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002041stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2042 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2043 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2044 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002045 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002046 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002047
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002048 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2049 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2050 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002051
2052stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2053 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2054 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002055 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002056
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002057strict-limits
2058 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2059 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2060 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2061 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2062 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002063
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002064uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002065 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002066 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2067 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2068 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2069
2070ulimit-n <number>
2071 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2072 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2073 option.
2074
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002075unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2076 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2077
2078 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2079 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2080 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2081 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2082 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002084 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2085 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2086 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2087 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2088
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002089unsetenv [<name> ...]
2090 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2091 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2092 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2093 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2094 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2095 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2096 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2097
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002098user <user name>
2099 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2100 See also "uid" and "group".
2101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002102node <name>
2103 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2104
2105 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2106 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2107 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2108 traffic.
2109
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002110wurfl-cache-size <size>
2111 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2112 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2113 - "0" : no cache is used.
2114 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002115
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002116 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2117 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002118
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002119wurfl-data-file <file path>
2120 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2121 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2122
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002123 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002124 with USE_WURFL=1.
2125
2126wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2127 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2128 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2129 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2130
2131 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2132
2133 Valid WURFL properties are:
2134 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2135
2136 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2137 device.
2138
2139 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2140 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2141
2142 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2143 particular web request.
2144
2145 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2146 used Libwurfl API version.
2147
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002148 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2149 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2150
2151 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2152 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2153
2154 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2155
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002156 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002157 with USE_WURFL=1.
2158
2159wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2160 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2161 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2162
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002163 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002164 with USE_WURFL=1.
2165
2166wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2167 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2168 thus before the chroot.
2169
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002170 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002171 with USE_WURFL=1.
2172
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021733.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002174-----------------------
2175
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002176busy-polling
2177 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2178 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2179 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2180 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2181 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2182 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2183 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2184 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2185 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2186 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2187 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2188 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2189 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2190 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2191 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2192 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2193 "poll" pollers.
2194
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002195 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2196 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2197 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2198
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002200 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002201 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2202 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2203 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2204 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2205 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2206 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2207 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2208
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002209maxcompcpuusage <number>
2210 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2211 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2212 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2213 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2214 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2215 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2216 and from introducing high latencies.
2217
2218maxcomprate <number>
2219 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2220 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2221 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2222 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2223 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2224 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2225 default value.
2226
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002227maxconn <number>
2228 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2229 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2230 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002231 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2232 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2233 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2234 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002235 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2236 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2237 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2238 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2239 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2240 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002241
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002242maxconnrate <number>
2243 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2244 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2245 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2246 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2247 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2248 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2249 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2250 fairness.
2251
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002252maxpipes <number>
2253 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2254 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2255 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2256 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2257 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2258 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2259
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002260maxsessrate <number>
2261 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2262 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2263 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2264 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2265 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2266 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2267 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2268 fairness.
2269
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002270maxsslconn <number>
2271 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2272 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2273 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2274 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2275 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2276 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2277 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002278 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2279 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2280 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2281 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002282 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002283 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2284 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002285
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002286maxsslrate <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2288 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2289 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2290 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2291 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2292 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2293 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2294 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2295 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2296 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2297
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002298maxzlibmem <number>
2299 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2300 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2301 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002302 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2303 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2304 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2305
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002306no-memory-trimming
2307 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2308 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2309 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2310 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2311 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2312 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2313 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2314 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2315 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2316 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2317 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2318 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2319 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2320 not suffer from such a problem.
2321
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002322noepoll
2323 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2324 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002325 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002326
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002327noevports
2328 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2329 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2330 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2331 also "nopoll".
2332
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002333nogetaddrinfo
2334 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2335 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2336
2337nokqueue
2338 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2339 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2340 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2341
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002342nopoll
2343 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2344 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002346 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2347 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002348
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002349noreuseport
2350 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2351 command line argument "-dR".
2352
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002353nosplice
2354 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002355 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002356 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002357 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002358 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2359 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2360 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2361 "option splice-response".
2362
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002363profiling.memory { on | off }
2364 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2365 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2366 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2367 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2368 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2369 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2370 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2371 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2372 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2373
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002374profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2375 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2376 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2377 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2378 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002379 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002380 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2381 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2382 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2383 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2384
2385 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2386 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2387 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2388 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2389 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002390 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2391 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2392 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2393 CLI.
2394
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002395spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002396 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2397 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2398 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2399 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2400 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2401 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002403ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002404 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002405 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002406 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002407 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002408 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2409 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2410 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2412 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002413 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2414 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2415 openssl configuration file uses:
2416 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2417
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002418ssl-mode-async
2419 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002420 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002421 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2422 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002423 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002424 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002425 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002426
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002427tune.buffers.limit <number>
2428 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2429 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2430 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2431 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2432 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002433 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002434 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2435 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2436 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2437 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2438 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2439 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2440 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2441 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002442 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002443
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002444tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2445 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2446 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2447 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002448 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002449
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002450tune.bufsize <number>
2451 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2452 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2453 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2454 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2455 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2456 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2457 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002458 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2459 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002460 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002461 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002462 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002463 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2464 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002465
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002466tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2467 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002468
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002469tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2470 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2471 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2472 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2473 this value. The default value is 1.
2474
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002475tune.fail-alloc
2476 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2477 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2478 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2479 gracefully.
2480
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002481tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2482 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2483 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2484 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2485 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2486 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2487
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002488tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2489 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2490 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2491 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2492 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2493 change it.
2494
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002495tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2496 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002497 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002498 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002499 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2500 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2501 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2502 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2503 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2504
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002505tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2506 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2507 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2508 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2509 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2510 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002511 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002512 recommended not to change this value.
2513
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002514tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002515 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002516 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002518 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2519 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2520 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2521 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2522
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002523tune.http.cookielen <number>
2524 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2525 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2526 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2527 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2528 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2529 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2530 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2531 to change this value.
2532
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002533tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002534 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2535 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002536 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002537 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002538 configuration directives too.
2539 The default value is 1024.
2540
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002541tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2542 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2543 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2544 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2545 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2546 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2547 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002548 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2549 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2550 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002551
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002552tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2553 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2554 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2555 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2556 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2557 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2558 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002559 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2560 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2561 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2562 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2563 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002564
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002565tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002566 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002567 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2568 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2569 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2570 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002571 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002572 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002573 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002574 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2575
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002576tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2577 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2578 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2579 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2580 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2581 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2582 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2583 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2584 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2585 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2586
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002587tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2588 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002589 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002590 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2591 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002593 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2594 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2595
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002596tune.lua.maxmem
2597 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2598 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2599 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2600 memory.
2601
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002602tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2603 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002604 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2605 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002606 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002607
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002608tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2609 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2610 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2611 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002612 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002614tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2615 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2616 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2617 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2618 check servers.
2619
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002620tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002621 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2622 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002623 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2624 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2625 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2626 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2627 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2628 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2629 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2630 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2631 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002632
2633tune.maxpollevents <number>
2634 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2635 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2636 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2637 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2638 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2639
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002640tune.maxrewrite <number>
2641 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2642 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2643 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2644 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2645 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2646 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2647 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2648 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2649 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2650 bufsize.
2651
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002652tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2653 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2654 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2655 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2656 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2657 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2658 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2659 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2660 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2661 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002662 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2663 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002664 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2665 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2666 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2667 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2668 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2669 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2670 setting this parameter to 0.
2671
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002672tune.pipesize <number>
2673 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2674 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2675 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2676 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2677 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2678 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2679
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002680tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2681 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002682 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002683 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2684 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2685 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2686 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002687 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002688
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002689tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2690 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002691 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002692 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2693 default is 20.
2694
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002695tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2696tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2697 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2698 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2699 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002700 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002701 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002702 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2703 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2704
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002705tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002706 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002707 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2708 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2709 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2710 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2711
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002712tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002713 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002714 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2715 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2716 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2717 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2718 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2719 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2720 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002721
2722tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2723 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002724 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002725 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2726 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2727 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2728 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2729 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2730 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2731 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002732
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002733tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2734tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2735 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2736 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2737 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002738 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002739 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002740 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2741 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2742 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2743 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002744 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002745
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002746tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002747 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002748 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2749 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2750 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2751 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2752 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2753 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2754 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2755 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2756 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2757 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2758 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002759
Willy Tarreau0cb29002022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002760tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2761 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2762 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2763 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2764 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2765
2766tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2767 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2768 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2769 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2770 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
2771 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
2772 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
2773 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
2774 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
2775 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
2776 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
2777 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
2778 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
2779
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002780tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002781 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002782 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2783 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2784 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2785 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2786 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2787
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002788tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2789 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2790 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2791 performances. This is disabled by default.
2792
2793 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2794 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2795
2796 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2797
2798 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2799
2800 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2801
2802 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2803 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2804 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2805
2806 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2807 converted.
2808
2809 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2810 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2811 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2812 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2813 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2814 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2815 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002816 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2817 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002818
2819 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2820
2821 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2822 only need this line:
2823
2824 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2825
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002826tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2827 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002828 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002829 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2830 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2831 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2832 being used for too long.
2833
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002834tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2835 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2836 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2837 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2838 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2839 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2840 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2841 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2842 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2843 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2844 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002845 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002846 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002847
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002848tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2849 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2850 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2851 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2852 1000 entries.
2853
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002854tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002855tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002856tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2857tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2858tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002859 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2860 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2861 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2862 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2863 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2864 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2865 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2866 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002867
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002868 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2869 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2870 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2871 all available space is consumed.
2872 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2873 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2874 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002875
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2877 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002878 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002879 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002880 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002881 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2882
2883tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2884 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2885 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002886 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2887 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002888
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028893.3. Debugging
2890--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002891
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002892quiet
2893 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2894 line argument "-q".
2895
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002896zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002898 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2899 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2900 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2901 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2902 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2903
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029053.4. Userlists
2906--------------
2907It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2908http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2909it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2910
2911userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002912 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002913 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2914
2915group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002916 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2918 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2919
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002920user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2921 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002922 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2923 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2925 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2926 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2927 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002928
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002929 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2930 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2931 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2932 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2933 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2934 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2935 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002936 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002937 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
2939 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002940 userlist L1
2941 group G1 users tiger,scott
2942 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002943
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002944 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2945 user scott insecure-password elgato
2946 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002947
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002948 userlist L2
2949 group G1
2950 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002951
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002952 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2953 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2954 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002955
2956 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002957
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002958
29593.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002960----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002961It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002962several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002963instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2964values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2965automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2966In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2967using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2968tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2969reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2970Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2971that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2972each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002973
2974peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002975 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002976 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2977
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002978bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2979 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2980 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2981
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002982disabled
2983 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2984 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2985 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2986
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002987default-bind [param*]
2988 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2989
2990default-server [param*]
2991 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2992
2993 Arguments:
2994 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2995 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002996 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2997 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2998 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2999 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003000
3001 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3002
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003003enabled
3004 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3005 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003006
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003007log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003008 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3009 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3010 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3011 more details.
3012
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003013peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3015 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003016 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003017 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003018 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3019 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3020 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003021
3022 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3023 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3024
3025 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003026 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3027 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3028 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003029
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003030 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3031 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003032
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003033 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3034 "server" keyword explanation below).
3035
3036server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003037 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3039 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3040 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3041 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003042
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003043 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3044 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3045 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3046 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3047 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003048
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003049 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003050 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003051 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003052 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3053 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3054 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003055
3056 backend mybackend
3057 mode tcp
3058 balance roundrobin
3059 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3060 stick on src
3061
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003062 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3063 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003064
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003065 Example:
3066 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003067 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3068 default-server ssl verify none
3069 server haproxy1 #local peer
3070 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3071 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003072
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003073
3074table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3075 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3076
3077 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3078 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003079 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003080 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3081 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3082 "stick-table" keyword).
3083
3084 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3085 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3086 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3087 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3088 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3089 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3090 of the stick-table name as follows:
3091
3092 peers mypeers
3093 peer A ...
3094 peer B ...
3095 table t1 ...
3096
3097 frontend fe1
3098 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3099
3100 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3101 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3102
3103 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3104 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3105 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3106 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3107 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3108 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3109 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3110
3111 peers mypeers
3112 peer A ...
3113 peer B ...
3114 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3115
3116 backend t1
3117 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3118
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003119 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003120 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3121 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3122
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031233.6. Mailers
3124------------
3125It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3126If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3127in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3128
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003129mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003130 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3131 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3132
3133mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3134 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3135
3136 Example:
3137 mailers mymailers
3138 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3139 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3140
3141 backend mybackend
3142 mode tcp
3143 balance roundrobin
3144
3145 email-alert mailers mymailers
3146 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3147 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3148
3149 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3150 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3151
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003152timeout mail <time>
3153 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3154 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3155 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3156 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3157
3158 Example:
3159 mailers mymailers
3160 timeout mail 20s
3161 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003162
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031633.7. Programs
3164-------------
3165In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3166master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3167managed the same way as the workers.
3168
3169During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3170sequence as a worker:
3171
3172 - the master is re-executed
3173 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3174 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3175 instance of the program
3176
3177During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3178
3179program <name>
3180 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3181 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3182 the management guide).
3183
3184command <command> [arguments*]
3185 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3186 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3187 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3188 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3189
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003190user <user name>
3191 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3192 See also "group".
3193
3194group <group name>
3195 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3196 See also "user".
3197
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003198option start-on-reload
3199no option start-on-reload
3200 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3201 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3202 program section.
3203
3204
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032053.8. HTTP-errors
3206----------------
3207
3208It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3209imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3210several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3211
3212http-errors <name>
3213 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3214 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3215
3216errorfile <code> <file>
3217 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3218
3219 Arguments :
3220 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003221 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003222 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003223
3224 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3225 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3226 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3227 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3228 before any chroot is performed.
3229
3230 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3231
3232 Example:
3233 http-errors website-1
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
3238 http-errors website-2
3239 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3240 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3241 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032433.9. Rings
3244----------
3245
3246It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3247servers or traces.
3248
3249ring <ringname>
3250 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3251
3252description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003253 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003254 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3255
3256format <format>
3257 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3258
3259 Arguments:
3260 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3261 one of the following :
3262
3263 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3264 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3265 designed to be used with a local log server.
3266
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003267 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3268 field is stripped. This is the default.
3269 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3270 rfc3164.
3271
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003272 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3273 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3274 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3275 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3276 is the default.
3277
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003278 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003279 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3280
3281 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3282 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3283
3284 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3285 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3286 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3287 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3288 logger consumes.
3289
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003290 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3291 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3292 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3293 with a local log server.
3294
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003295 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3296 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3297 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3298 used with a local log server.
3299
3300maxlen <length>
3301 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3302 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3303 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3304
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003305server <name> <address> [param*]
3306 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3307 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3308 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3309 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3310 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3311 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3312 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3313 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3314 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003315 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3316 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003318size <size>
3319 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3320 set to BUFSIZE.
3321
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003322timeout connect <timeout>
3323 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3324
3325 Arguments :
3326 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3327 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3328 as explained at the top of this document.
3329
3330timeout server <timeout>
3331 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3332
3333 Arguments :
3334 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3335 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3336 as explained at the top of this document.
3337
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 Example:
3339 global
3340 log ring@myring local7
3341
3342 ring myring
3343 description "My local buffer"
3344 format rfc3164
3345 maxlen 1200
3346 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003347 timeout connect 5s
3348 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003349 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003350
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033513.10. Log forwarding
3352-------------------
3353
3354It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003355HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003356
3357log-forward <name>
3358 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3359
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003360backlog <conns>
3361 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3362 on connections accept.
3363
3364bind <addr> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003366 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3367 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3368 syslog protocol over TCP.
3369 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003370 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3371
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003372dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003373 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3374 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3375 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3376 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003377 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003378
3379log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003380log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003381 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3382 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3383 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003384 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003385 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3386 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3387 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003388 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003389
3390 Example:
3391 global
3392 log stderr format iso local7
3393
3394 ring myring
3395 description "My local buffer"
3396 format rfc5424
3397 maxlen 1200
3398 size 32764
3399 timeout connect 5s
3400 timeout server 10s
3401 # syslog tcp server
3402 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3403
3404 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003405 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3406 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003407 # all messages on stderr
3408 log global
3409 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3410 log ring@myring local0
3411 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3412 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3413 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3414 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3415 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003416
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003417maxconn <conns>
3418 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3419 10 is the default.
3420
3421timeout client <timeout>
3422 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003425----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003428 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3429 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3430 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3431 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003432
3433A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3434connections.
3435
3436A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3437to forward incoming connections.
3438
3439A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3440parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3441
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003442A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3443ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3444sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3445the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3446explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3447from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3448"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3449for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3450to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3451optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3452are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3453any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3454names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3455that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3456duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3457names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3458
3459Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3460settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3461of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3462profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3463timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3466'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3467case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3468
3469Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3470logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3471proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3472However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3473name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3474
3475Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3476and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003477bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003478protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3479modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3480arbitrary criteria.
3481
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003482In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3483a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003484the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485
3486 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3487 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3488 between responses and new requests.
3489
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003490 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3491 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3492 client-facing connection remains open.
3493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003494 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3495 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
3497The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3498frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3499following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003500weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003501
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003502 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003503
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003504 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3505 ----+-----+-----+----
3506 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3507 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003508 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3509 ----+-----+-----+----
3510 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003511
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003513only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3514within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3518possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003519
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003520There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003521first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003522processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003523second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003524protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3525is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3526new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003527to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003528process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3529already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3530HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3531evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3532one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3533
3534There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3535performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3536tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3537preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3538analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3539HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3540header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3541mitigate this drawback.
3542
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003544method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3545set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3546in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3547is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3548to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3549above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3550to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3551"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3552frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3553frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3554as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3555upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3556on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3557the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3558upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3559frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3560remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035624.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3563--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3566limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3567they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3568limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003569marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003570option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003571and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3572with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3573specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003575
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003576 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3577------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3578acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003579backlog X X X -
3580balance X - X X
3581bind - X X -
3582bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003583capture cookie - X X -
3584capture request header - X X -
3585capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003586clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3587clitcpka-idle X X X -
3588clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003589compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003590cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003591declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003592default-server X - X X
3593default_backend X X X -
3594description - X X X
3595disabled X X X X
3596dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003597email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003598email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003599email-alert mailers X X X X
3600email-alert myhostname X X X X
3601email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003602enabled X X X X
3603errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003604errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605errorloc X X X X
3606errorloc302 X X X X
3607-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3608errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003609force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003610filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003611fullconn X - X X
3612grace X X X X
3613hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003614http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003615http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003617http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003618http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003619http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003620http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003621http-check set-var X - X X
3622http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003623http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003624http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003625http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003626http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003627http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003628id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003629ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003630load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003631log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003632log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003633log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003634log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003635max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003636maxconn X X X -
3637mode X X X X
3638monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003639monitor-uri X X X -
3640option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3641option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3642option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3643option allbackups (*) X - X X
3644option checkcache (*) X - X X
3645option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3646option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003647option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3649option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003650-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3651option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003652option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3653option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003654option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003655option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003656option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003657option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003658option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003659option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3661option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3662option httpchk X - X X
3663option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003664option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003665option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003666option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003667option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003668option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003669option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3670option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3671option logasap (*) X X X -
3672option mysql-check X - X X
3673option nolinger (*) X X X X
3674option originalto X X X X
3675option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003676option pgsql-check X - X X
3677option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003679option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003680option smtpchk X - X X
3681option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3682option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3683option splice-request (*) X X X X
3684option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003685option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003686option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3687option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3688-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003689option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003690option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3691option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3692option tcpka X X X X
3693option tcplog X X X X
3694option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003695option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003696external-check command X - X X
3697external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003698persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3699rate-limit sessions X X X -
3700redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003703retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003705server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003706server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003707source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003708srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3709srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3710srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003711stats admin - X X X
3712stats auth X X X X
3713stats enable X X X X
3714stats hide-version X X X X
3715stats http-request - X X X
3716stats realm X X X X
3717stats refresh X X X X
3718stats scope X X X X
3719stats show-desc X X X X
3720stats show-legends X X X X
3721stats show-node X X X X
3722stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003723-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3724stick match - - X X
3725stick on - - X X
3726stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003727stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003728stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003729tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003730tcp-check connect X - X X
3731tcp-check expect X - X X
3732tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003733tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003734tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003735tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003736tcp-check set-var X - X X
3737tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003738tcp-request connection - X X -
3739tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003740tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003741tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003742tcp-response content - - X X
3743tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744timeout check X - X X
3745timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003746timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003747timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3749timeout http-request X X X X
3750timeout queue X - X X
3751timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003752timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003754timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003755transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003756unique-id-format X X X -
3757unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003758use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003759use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003760use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003761------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3762 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3766---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003767
3768This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3769
3770
3771acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3772 Declare or complete an access list.
3773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3774 no | yes | yes | yes
3775 Example:
3776 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3777 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3778 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3779
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003780 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003781
3782
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003783backlog <conns>
3784 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3785 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3786 yes | yes | yes | no
3787 Arguments :
3788 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3789 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003790 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003791
3792 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3793 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3794 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3795 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3796 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3797 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3798 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3799 backlog parameter.
3800
3801 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3802 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3803 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3804
3805 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3806
3807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003808balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003809balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003810 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments :
3814 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3815 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3816 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3817 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3818
3819 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3820 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3821 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3822 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003823 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003824 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003825 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3826 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3827 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3828 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3829 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3830 it, so that you don't worry.
3831
3832 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3833 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3834 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3835 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3836 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3837 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3838 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3839 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003840
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003841 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3842 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3843 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3844 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3845 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3846 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3847 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003848 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3849 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3850 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003851
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003853 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003854 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3855 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003856 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003857 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3858 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3859 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3860 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3861 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003862 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3863 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3864 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3865 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3866 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3867 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003869 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3870 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3871 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3872 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3873 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3874 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3875 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3876 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003877 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003878 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003879 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3880 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3881 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003882
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003883 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3884 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3885 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3886 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3887 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3888 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3889 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3890 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3891 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3892 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3893 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3894 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003895
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003896 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003897 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3898 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3899 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3900 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3901 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3902 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3903 URIs start with a leading "/".
3904
3905 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3906 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3907 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3908 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3909
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003910 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3911 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3912 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3913 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3914
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003915 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003916 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3917
3918 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003919 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3920 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3922 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3923 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3924 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003925 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003926 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3927 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003928
3929 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3930 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3931 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3932 server will receive the request.
3933
3934 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3935 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3936 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3937 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3938 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003939 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3940 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3941 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003943 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3944 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3945 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3946 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3947 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003948
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003949 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003950 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3951 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3952 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3953
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003954 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3955 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3956 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3957
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003958 random
3959 random(<draws>)
3960 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003961 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3962 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3963 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3964 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003965 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3966 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3967 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3968 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3969 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3970 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3971 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3972 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3973 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3974 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3975 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3976 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3977 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3978 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3979 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3980 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3981 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3982 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3983 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3984 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003985
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003987 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003988 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3989 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003990 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003991 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3992 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3993 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003994 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003995 used instead.
3996
3997 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3998 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3999 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004000 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004001
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004002 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4003 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4004 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4005
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004007 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4008 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004009
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004010 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4011 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4012 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004013
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004014 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004015 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004016 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4017 NTLM relies on.
4018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004019 Examples :
4020 balance roundrobin
4021 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004022 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004023 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4024 balance hdr(host)
4025 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026
4027 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4028 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004030 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004031 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4032 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4033 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004034 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004035
4036 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4037 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4038 defaults to 16 kB.
4039
4040 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4041 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4042
4043 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4044 Round Robin.
4045
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004046 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004047 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4048 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4049 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4050
4051 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4052
4053 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004054 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004055 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4056 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4057 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004058
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004059 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004060
4061
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004062bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4063bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004064 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4065 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4066 no | yes | yes | no
4067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004068 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4069 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4070 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4071 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004072 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004073 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4074 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4075 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4076 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4077 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4078 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004079 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004080 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4081 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004082 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004083 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4084 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004085 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004086 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4087 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004088 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004089 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4090 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4091 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4092 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4093 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4094 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4095 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004096 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4097 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4098 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004099 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4100 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4101 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4102 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004103 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4104 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4105 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004106
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4108 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004109 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4110 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4111 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004112 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4113 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4114 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4115 the range.
4116
4117 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4118 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4119 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4120 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4121 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4122 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4123 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004124 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004125 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004127 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004128 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004129 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4130 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4131 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4132 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4133 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4134 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4135
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004136 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4137 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4138 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4139 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004140
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4142 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4143 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4144 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4145 in a frontend.
4146
4147 Example :
4148 listen http_proxy
4149 bind :80,:443
4150 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004151 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004152
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004153 listen http_https_proxy
4154 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004155 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004156
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004157 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4158 bind ipv6@:80
4159 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4160 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4161
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004162 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004163 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004164
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004165 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4166 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4167 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4168 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4169 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4170
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004171 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004172 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004173
4174
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004175bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004176 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | yes
4179 Arguments :
4180 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4181 may be used to override a default value.
4182
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004183 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004184 option may be combined with other numbers.
4185
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004186 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004187 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4188 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4189 missing from all processes.
4190
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004191 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004192 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004193 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4194 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4195 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4196 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4197 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004198 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004199
4200 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4201 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4202 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4203 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4204 and 'even' instances.
4205
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004206 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4207 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4208 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4209 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004210
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004211 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4212 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4213
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004214 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4215 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4216 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4217
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004218 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4219 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4220
4221 Example :
4222 listen app_ip1
4223 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004224 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004225
4226 listen app_ip2
4227 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004228 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004229
4230 listen management
4231 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004232 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004233
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004234 listen management
4235 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4236 bind-process 1-4
4237
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004238 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004239
4240
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004241capture cookie <name> len <length>
4242 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | no
4245 Arguments :
4246 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4247 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4248 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4249 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004250 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004251
4252 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4253 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4254 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4255 right if it exceeds <length>.
4256
4257 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4258 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4259 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4260 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4261
4262 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4263 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4264 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4265
4266 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4267 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4268 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004269 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4270 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4271 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004272
4273 Example:
4274 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4275
4276 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004277 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
4279
4280capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004281 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4283 no | yes | yes | no
4284 Arguments :
4285 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004286 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4288 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4289 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4290
4291 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4292 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4293 it exceeds <length>.
4294
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004295 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004296 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4297 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4299 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4300 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4301 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004302 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004303 environments to find where the request came from.
4304
4305 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4306 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4307 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4308 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004310 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4311 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4312 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4313 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4314 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
4316 Example:
4317 capture request header Host len 15
4318 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004319 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004321 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 about logging.
4323
4324
4325capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004326 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4328 no | yes | yes | no
4329 Arguments :
4330 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004331 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004332 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4333 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4334 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4335
4336 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4337 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4338 it exceeds <length>.
4339
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004340 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4342 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4343 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004344 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4345 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4346 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4347 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004348
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004349 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4350 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4351 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4352 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4353 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354
4355 Example:
4356 capture response header Content-length len 9
4357 capture response header Location len 15
4358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004359 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360 about logging.
4361
4362
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004363clitcpka-cnt <count>
4364 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4365 the connection on the client side.
4366 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4367 yes | yes | yes | no
4368 Arguments :
4369 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4370
4371 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4372 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004373 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4374 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004375
4376 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4377
4378
4379clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4380 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4381 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4382 client side.
4383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4384 yes | yes | yes | no
4385 Arguments :
4386 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4387 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4388 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4389 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4390
4391 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4392 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004393 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4394 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004395
4396 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4397
4398
4399clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4400 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4402 yes | yes | yes | no
4403 Arguments :
4404 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4405 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4406 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4407 document.
4408
4409 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4410 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004411 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4412 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004413
4414 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4415
4416
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004417compression algo <algorithm> ...
4418compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004419compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004420 Enable HTTP compression.
4421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4422 yes | yes | yes | yes
4423 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004424 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4425 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004426 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
4428 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004429 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4430 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4431 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004432
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004433 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004434 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004435
4436 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4437 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4438 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4439 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4440 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004441 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004442
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004443 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4444 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4445 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4446 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4447 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4448 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4449 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004450 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004451
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004452 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004454 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004456 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004457 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004458 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004459
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004460 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004461 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4462 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004463 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4464 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4468 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004469 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004470 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4471 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004472
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004473 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004474 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4475 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004476 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004477 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004478 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4479 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4480 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4481 "multipart"
4482 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4483 header
4484 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4485 and later
4486 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4487 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004488 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004489
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004490 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004491
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004492 Examples :
4493 compression algo gzip
4494 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004495
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004496
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004497cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004498 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4499 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004500 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4503 yes | no | yes | yes
4504 Arguments :
4505 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4506 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4507 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4508 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4509 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4510 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004511 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4513 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4514
4515 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004516 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4518 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4519 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4520 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004521 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4522 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004523 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004524 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4525 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004526
4527 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004528 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004530 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004531 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004532 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004533 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004534 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4535 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4536 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4537 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4538 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4539 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4540 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004541
4542 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4543 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4544 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4545 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4546 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4547 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4548 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4549 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4550 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004551 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004552 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4553 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4554 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004555
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004556 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4557 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4558 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004559 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4560 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4561 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4562 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004563 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4564 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4565 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004566
4567 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4568 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4569 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4570 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4571 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4572 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4573 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4574 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4575 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4576
4577 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4578 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4579 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4580 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4581 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4582 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4583 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4584 persistence cookie in the cache.
4585 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4586
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004587 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4588 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004589 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004590 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4591 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004592 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004593 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4594 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4595 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4596 they logout.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4600 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4601 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4602
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004603 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004604 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4605 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4606 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4607 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4608 this attribute.
4609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004610 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004611 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004612 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4613 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4614 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4615 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4616 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4617 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004618
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4620 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4621 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4622 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4623 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4624 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4625 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4626 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004627 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004628 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4629 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4630 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4631 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4632 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4633 the site.
4634
4635 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4636 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4637 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4638 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4639 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4640 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4641 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4642 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4643 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4644 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4645 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4646 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4647 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004648 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004649 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4650 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4651
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004652 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4653 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4654 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4655 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4656 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4657 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4658
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004659 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004660 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4661 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4662 repeated.
4663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4665 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4666 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4667 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Examples :
4670 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4671 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4672 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004673 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004674
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004675 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004676
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004677
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004678declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4679 Declares a capture slot.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | no
4682 Arguments:
4683 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4684
4685 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4686 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4687 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4688 for use in the response.
4689
4690 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004691 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004692 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4693
4694
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004695default-server [param*]
4696 Change default options for a server in a backend
4697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4698 yes | no | yes | yes
4699 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4701 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4702 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4703 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004706 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4707
4708 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004709
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004710
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711default_backend <backend>
4712 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | no
4715 Arguments :
4716 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4717
4718 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4719 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4720 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4721 will catch all undetermined requests.
4722
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004723 Example :
4724
4725 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4726 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4727 default_backend dynamic
4728
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004729 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004731
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004732description <string>
4733 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 no | yes | yes | yes
4736 Arguments : string
4737
4738 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4739 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4740 it describes.
4741 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4742
4743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744disabled
4745 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4747 yes | yes | yes | yes
4748 Arguments : none
4749
4750 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4751 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4752 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4753 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4754 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4755 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4756 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4757
4758 See also : "enabled"
4759
4760
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761dispatch <address>:<port>
4762 Set a default server address
4763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4764 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004765 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004766
4767 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4768 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4769 during start-up.
4770
4771 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4772 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4773 possible with normal servers.
4774
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004775 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004776 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4777 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4778 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4779 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4780
4781 See also : "server"
4782
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004783
4784dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4785 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4789
4790 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004791 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004792 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4793 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004794 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004795 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004797enabled
4798 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4799 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4800 yes | yes | yes | yes
4801 Arguments : none
4802
4803 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4804 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4805
4806 See also : "disabled"
4807
4808
4809errorfile <code> <file>
4810 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4812 yes | yes | yes | yes
4813 Arguments :
4814 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004815 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004816 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004817
4818 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004819 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004820 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004821 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4822 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004823
4824 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4825 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4826 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4827
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004828 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4829
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004830 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4831 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4832 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4833 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4834 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4835 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4836 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4837 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4838 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4841 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4842 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004843 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004846 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004847
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004848 Example :
4849 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004850 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004851 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4852 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004854
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004855errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4856 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4857 section.
4858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4859 yes | yes | yes | yes
4860 Arguments :
4861 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4862
4863 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004864 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004865 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4866 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004867
4868 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4869 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4870 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4871 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4872 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004873 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004874 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4875
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004876 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4877 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004878
4879 Example :
4880 errorfiles generic
4881 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4882
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884errorloc <code> <url>
4885errorloc302 <code> <url>
4886 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4887 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | yes | yes | yes
4889 Arguments :
4890 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004891 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004892 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004893
4894 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4895 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4896 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4897 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004898 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004899
4900 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4901 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4902 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4903
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004904 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4907 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4908 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4909 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004910 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4912 request.
4913
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004914 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004915
4916
4917errorloc303 <code> <url>
4918 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4920 yes | yes | yes | yes
4921 Arguments :
4922 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004923 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004924 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004925
4926 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4927 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4928 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4929 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004930 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
4932 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4933 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4934 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4935
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004936 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4939 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4940 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4941 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004942 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004943
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004944 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945
4946
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004947email-alert from <emailaddr>
4948 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004949 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004950 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | yes
4952
4953 Arguments :
4954
4955 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4956
4957 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4958 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4959
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004960 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004961 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4962 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004963
4964
4965email-alert level <level>
4966 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4967 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4969 yes | yes | yes | yes
4970
4971 Arguments :
4972
4973 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4974 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4975 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4976
4977 By default level is alert
4978
4979 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4980 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4981 for the proxy.
4982
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004983 Alerts are sent when :
4984
4985 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4986 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4987 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4988 is notice or lower
4989 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4990 and a health check status update occurs
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4993 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004994 section 3.6 about mailers.
4995
4996
4997email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4998 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4999 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | yes | yes | yes
5001
5002 Arguments :
5003
5004 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5005
5006 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5007 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5008
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005009 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5010 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005011
5012
5013email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5014 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5015 mailers.
5016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | yes
5018
5019 Arguments :
5020
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005021 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005022
5023 By default the systems hostname is used.
5024
5025 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5026 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5027 for the proxy.
5028
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005029 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5030 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005031
5032
5033email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005034 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005035 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 yes | yes | yes | yes
5038
5039 Arguments :
5040
5041 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5042
5043 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5044 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5045
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005046 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005047 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5048
5049
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005050force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5051 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5052 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005053 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005054
5055 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5056 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5057 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5058 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5059 marked down for maintenance operations.
5060
5061 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5062 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5063 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5064 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5065 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5066 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5067 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5068 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5069 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5070
5071 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5072 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5073 is used.
5074
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005075 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005076 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005077
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005078
5079filter <name> [param*]
5080 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | yes | yes | yes
5083 Arguments :
5084 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5085 referenced in section 9.
5086
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005087 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005088 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005089 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5090 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005091
5092 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5093 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5094
5095 Example:
5096 listen
5097 bind *:80
5098
5099 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5100 filter compression
5101 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5102
5103 compression algo gzip
5104 compression offload
5105
5106 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5107
5108 See also : section 9.
5109
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005110
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005111fullconn <conns>
5112 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5114 yes | no | yes | yes
5115 Arguments :
5116 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5117 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5118
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005119 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005120 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005121 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005122 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5123 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5124 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5125 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5126 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005127 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005129 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005130 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005131 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5132 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5133 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005134
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005135 Example :
5136 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5137 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5138 # connections.
5139 backend dynamic
5140 fullconn 10000
5141 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5142 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5143
5144 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5145
5146
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005147grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005148 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005150 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151 Arguments :
5152 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5153 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5154 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5155
5156 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5157 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005158 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005159 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5160
5161 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5162 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5163 simplify it.
5164
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005165
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005166hash-balance-factor <factor>
5167 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | no | yes
5170 Arguments :
5171 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5172 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005173 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005174
5175 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5176 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5177 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5178 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5179 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5180 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5181 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5182
5183 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5184 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5185 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5186 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5187 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5188
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005189 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5190 consistent hashing mechanism.
5191
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005192 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5193
5194
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005195hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005196 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5198 yes | no | yes | yes
5199 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005200 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5201 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005202
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005203 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5204 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5205 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5206 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5207 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5208 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5209 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5210 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5211 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5212 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005213
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005214 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5215 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5216 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5217 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5218 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5219 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5220 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5221 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5222 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5223 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5224 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5225 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5226 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005227 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5228 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005229
5230 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5231
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005232 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005233 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5234 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5235 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005236 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5237 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5238 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005239
5240 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5241 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005242 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5243 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5244 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5245 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5246
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005247 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005248 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5249 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5250 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5251 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5252 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5253 parameter.
5254
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005255 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5256 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5257 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5258 used on strings.
5259
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005260 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5261
5262 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5263 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5264 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5265 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5266 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5267 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5268 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5269 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5270 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5271 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5272 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5273 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005274
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005275 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5276 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5277 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005278
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005279 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005280
5281
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005282http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5283 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5284 ones).
5285
5286 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5287 no | yes | yes | yes
5288
5289 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5290 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5291 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5292 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5293 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5294 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5295
5296 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5297 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5298 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5299
5300 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5301 below.
5302
5303 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5304 instance.
5305
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005306 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5307 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5308 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005310 Example:
5311 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5312 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5313 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5314
5315http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5316
5317 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5318 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5319 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5320 example, or to pass some internal information.
5321 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5322 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5323 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5324
5325http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5326
5327 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5328 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5329
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005330http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005331
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005332 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5333 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5334 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5335 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5336 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337
5338http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5340
5341 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5342
5343 Example:
5344 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5345
5346 # applied to:
5347 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5348
5349 # outputs:
5350 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5351
5352 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5353
5354http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5356
5357 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5358
5359 Example:
5360 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5361
5362 # applied to:
5363 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5364
5365 # outputs:
5366 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5367
5368http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5369
5370 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5371 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5372 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5373
5374http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5378 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5379 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5380 fallback.
5381
5382 Example:
5383 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5384 http-response set-status 431
5385 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5386 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5387
5388http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389
5390 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5391 inline.
5392
5393 Arguments:
5394 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5395 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5396 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5397 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5398 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5399 (request and response)
5400 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5401 processing
5402 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5403 processing
5404 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5405 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5406 and '_'.
5407
5408 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5409 followed by some converters.
5410
5411 Example:
5412 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5413
5414http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5415
5416 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5417 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5418 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5419 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5420 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005421 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 processing.
5423
5424 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5425 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005426 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005427 rules evaluation.
5428
5429http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5430
5431 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5432 details about <var-name>.
5433
5434 Example:
5435 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5436
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005437
5438http-check comment <string>
5439 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5440 it fails.
5441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5442 yes | no | yes | yes
5443
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005444 Arguments :
5445 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5446 rule fails.
5447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005448 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5449 user-friendly error reporting.
5450
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005451 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005452 "http-check expect".
5453
5454
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005455http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5456 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005457 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5460 yes | no | yes | yes
5461
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5464
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005465 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005466 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005467
5468 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5469 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5470 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5471 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5472
5473 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5474
5475 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5476
5477 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5478
5479 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5480
5481 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5482
5483 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5484 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5485 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5486 is used.
5487
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005488 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5489 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5490 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5491 haproxy -vv.
5492
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005493 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5496 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5497 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5498 different ports or with different servers.
5499
5500 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5501 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5502 the port with a "http-check connect".
5503
5504 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5505 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5506 do.
5507
5508 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5509 unset-var or comment rules.
5510
5511 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005512 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5513 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5514 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5515 option httpchk
5516
5517 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005518 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005519 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005520 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523
5524 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5525
5526 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005527
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005529http-check disable-on-404
5530 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005533 Arguments : none
5534
5535 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5536 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5537 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5538 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5539 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5540 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5541 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5542 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5544 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005545 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5546 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5547 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005549 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005550
5551
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005552http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005553 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5554 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5555 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005556 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005558 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005559
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005561 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5562
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005563 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5564 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5565 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5566 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5567 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5568 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5569 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5570 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5571 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5572 result is always conclusive.
5573
5574 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5575 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5576 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005577 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5578 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005579 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5580 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005581 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5582 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5583 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005584
5585 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5586 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005587 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5588 supported :
5589 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5590 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005591 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5592 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5593 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5594 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5595 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005596
5597 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5598 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005599 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5600 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5601 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5602 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005603 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5604
5605 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5607 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5608 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5609
5610 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5611 informational message reported in logs if an error
5612 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5613 log-format string.
5614
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005615 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005616 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5617 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5619 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5620 details on the supported keywords.
5621
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005622 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5623 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5624 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5625 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005626
5627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5632
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005633 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5634 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5635 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5636 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5637 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5638 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5639 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005640
5641 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005642 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5644 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5645 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5646 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5647
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005648 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5649 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005650 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5651 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5652 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5653 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5654 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5655 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5656 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5657 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005658 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5659 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5660 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5661 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5662 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5663 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5664 insensitive on the header names.
5665
5666 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5667 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5668 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5669 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5670 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5671 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005672
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005673 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005674 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5676 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5677 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5678 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5679 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005680 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005681 trace).
5682
5683 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005684 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005685 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5686 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5687 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5688 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5689 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005690 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005691
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005692 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5694 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5695 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5696 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5697 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5698
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005699 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005700 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005701 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5702 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5703 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5704 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5705 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5706 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5707
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005708 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5709 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5710 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5711 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5712 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005713
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005714 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5715 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005719 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005720
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005721 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5722 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5723
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005725 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005726
5727 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005731 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005733 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005734 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005735
5736
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005737http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005738 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5739 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005740 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5741 health checks.
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 yes | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005745 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5746
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005747 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5748 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5749 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5750 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5751 to invent non-standard ones.
5752
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005753 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5755 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5756 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5757
5758 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5759 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5760 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5761 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005762
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005763 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005764 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005765 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005766 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5767 to add it.
5768
5769 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5770 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5771 to the log-format rules.
5772
5773 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5774 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5775 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005776
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005777 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5778 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5779 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5780 request.
5781
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005782 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5783 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5784 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005785 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5786 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5787 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5788 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005789 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005790
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005791 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5793 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005794
5795 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5796 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5797 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5798 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5799 configured request authority.
5800
5801 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5802 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005803
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005804 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005805
5806
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005807http-check send-state
5808 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5810 yes | no | yes | yes
5811 Arguments : none
5812
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005813 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005814 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005815 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5816 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5817 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005818
5819 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5820 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5821 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5822 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5823 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005824 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5825 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5826 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5827
5828 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5829 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5830 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5831
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5833 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5834 checked in multiple backends.
5835
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005836 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005837 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5838
5839 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5840 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5841 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5842 one fails.
5843
5844 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5845 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5846 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5847
5848 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5849 server's queue.
5850
5851 Example of a header received by the application server :
5852 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5853 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5854
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005855 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5856 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005857
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005858
5859http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5862 yes | no | yes | yes
5863
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005864 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5866 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5869 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5872 and '-'.
5873
5874 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5875
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005876 Examples :
5877 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005878
5879
5880http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | no | yes | yes
5884
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005885 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005886 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5887 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5888 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5889 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5890 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5892 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5893 and '-'.
5894
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005895 Examples :
5896 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005897
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005898
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005899http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5900 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5901 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5902 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5903 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5905 yes | yes | yes | yes
5906 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005907 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005908 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005909 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005910 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005911
5912 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5913 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5914 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5915 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5916
5917 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5918 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5919 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5920 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5921
5922 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5923 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5924 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5925 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5926 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5927 chroot is performed.
5928
5929 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5930 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5931 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5932 considered.
5933
5934 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5935 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5936 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5937 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5938 considered as a raw string.
5939
5940 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5941 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5942 "content-type".
5943
5944 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5945 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5946 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5947 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5948 evaluated as a log-format string.
5949
5950 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5951 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5952 argument to "content-type".
5953
5954 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5955 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5956 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5957 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5958
5959 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5960 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5961 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5962 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5963 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5964 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5965 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5966 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5967
5968 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5969 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5970 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5971
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005972 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5973 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5974 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5975 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5976 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5977
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005978 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5979 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5980
5981
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005982http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005983 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5984
5985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5986 no | yes | yes | yes
5987
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005988 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5989 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5990 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5991 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5992 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5995 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005996
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005997 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 Example:
6000 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6001 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6002 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 http-request allow if nagios
6005 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6006 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6007 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 Example:
6010 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6011 acl add path /addacl
6012 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006015
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006016 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6017 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 Example:
6020 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6021 acl setmap path /setmap
6022 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006026 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6027 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6030 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006031
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006032http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006033
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006034 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6035 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6036 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6037 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6038 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6039 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6040 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6041 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006045 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6046 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6047 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6048 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6049 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6050 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6051 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6052 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006054http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006055
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006056 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6057 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006058
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006060http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006062 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6063 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6064 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6065 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6066 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006067
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006068 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6069 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6070 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6071 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6072 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6073 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6074 instead.
6075
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006076 Example:
6077 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6078 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006079
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006080http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006081
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006082 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006084http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6085 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6088 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6089 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6090 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6091 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6092 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6093 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6094 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6095 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6098 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6099 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006100 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6101
6102 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6103 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6104 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6105 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006109 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6110 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6111 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6112 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6113 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6114 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006115
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006116http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006117
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006118 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6119 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6120 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6121 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6122 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6127 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6128 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6129 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6130 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6131 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006132
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006133http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6134http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6135 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6136 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6137 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6138 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006139
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006140 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6141 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6142 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006143 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006144 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6145 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6146 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006147 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006148 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006149
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006150http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6151 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6152 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6153 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6154
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006155http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6156
6157 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6158 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6159 pointed by <resolvers>.
6160 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6161 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6162 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6163 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6164 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6165 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6166 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6167 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6168 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6169 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006170 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6171 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006172
6173 Example:
6174 resolvers mydns
6175 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6176 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6177 timeout retry 1s
6178 hold valid 10s
6179 hold nx 3s
6180 hold other 3s
6181 hold obsolete 0s
6182 accepted_payload_size 8192
6183
6184 frontend fe
6185 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006186 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006187 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6188
6189 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6190 # which mean DNS resolution error
6191 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6192
6193 default_backend be
6194
6195 backend b_503
6196 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6197 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6198 # 503 error page to end users
6199
6200 backend be
6201 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6202 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6203 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6204 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6205 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6206
6207 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6208 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6209
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006210http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6211
6212 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6213 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6214 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6215 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006216 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6217 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006218
6219 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6220
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006221http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006222http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006223http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006224http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006225http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006226http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006227http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006228http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6229http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006230
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006231 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6232
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006233 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006234 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6235 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6236 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6237 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006238
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006239 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6240 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6241 the supported backend.
6242
6243 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6244 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6245 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6246 number of segments in the path.
6247
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006248 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6249 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6250 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6251 when improperly combined.
6252
6253 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6254 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6255 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6256 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6257 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6258
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006259 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006260
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006261 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6262
6263 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6264 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6265
6266 Example:
6267 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6268
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006269 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6270
6271 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6272 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6273
6274 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6275 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6276
6277 Example:
6278 - /#foo -> /
6279
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006280 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6281 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006282
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006283 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6284 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6285
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006286 Example:
6287 - /. -> /
6288 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6289 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6290 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006291
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006292 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6293 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6294
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006295 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006296 their preceding segment.
6297
6298 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6299 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6300
6301 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6302 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006303
6304 Example:
6305 - /foo/../ -> /
6306 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6307 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6308 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006309 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006310 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006311 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006312
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006313 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6314 removed as well:
6315
6316 Example:
6317 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6318 - /bar/../../ -> /
6319
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006320 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6321 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006322
6323 Example:
6324 - // -> /
6325 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6326
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006327 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6328 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6329
6330 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6331 ".", "_", and "~".
6332
6333 Example:
6334 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6335 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6336 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6337 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6338
6339 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6340 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6341
6342 Example:
6343 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6344 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6345
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006346 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006347 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006348
6349 Example:
6350 - /%6f -> /%6F
6351 - /%zz -> /%zz
6352
6353 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6354 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6355
6356 Example:
6357 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6358
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006359 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006360 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6361 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6362
6363 Example:
6364 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6365 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6366 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6367
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006368http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006369
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006370 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6371 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6372 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6373 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6374 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006375
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006376http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6379 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6380 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6381 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006382
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006383http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6384 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006385
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006386 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006387 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6388 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6389 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6390 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6391 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006392
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006393 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6394 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6395 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6396 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6397 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006398
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006399 Example:
6400 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6401
6402 # applied to:
6403 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6404
6405 # outputs:
6406 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6407
6408 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6411
6412 # applied to:
6413 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006414
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006415 # outputs:
6416 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006417
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006418http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6420
6421 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6422 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006423 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6424 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6425 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006426
6427 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6428 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6429 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6430
6431 Example:
6432 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6433 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6434
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006435 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6436 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6437 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6438 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6439
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006440http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6441 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6442
6443 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6444 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6445 query-string are replaced.
6446
6447 Example:
6448 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6449 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6450
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006451http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6453
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006454 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6455 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6456 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6457 against.
6458
6459 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6460 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6461 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006462
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006463 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6464 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6465 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6466 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6467 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6468 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6469 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6470 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6471 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006472 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6473 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006474
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006475 Example:
6476 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6477 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006478
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006479 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6480 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006481
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006482http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6483 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006485 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6486 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6487 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6488 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 Example:
6491 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006492
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006493 # applied to:
6494 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006495
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006496 # outputs:
6497 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006498
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006499http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6500 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6501 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006502 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6504
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6507 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006508 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006509 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006510 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006511 are followed to create the response :
6512
6513 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6514 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6515 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6516 ignored.
6517
6518 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6519 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006520 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006521 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6522 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006523
6524 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6525 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6526 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006527 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006528 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006529
6530 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6531 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6532 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006533 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006534 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006535 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006536
6537 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6538 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6539 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6540 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6541 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6542 as a raw content.
6543
6544 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6545 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6546 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6547 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6548 considered as a raw string.
6549
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006550 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006551 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6552 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6553 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6554
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006555 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6556 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006557 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558
6559 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6560
6561 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006562 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006563 if { path /ping }
6564
6565 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6566 if { path /favicon.ico }
6567
6568 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6569 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6570 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6571
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006572http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6573http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006574
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006575 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6576 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6577 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006578
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006579http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006582 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6583 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6584 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6585 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6590 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6591 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6592 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6593 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006595 Arguments:
6596 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6597 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 Example:
6600 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6601 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6604 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006606http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006608 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6609 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6610 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006612 Arguments:
6613 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6614 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 Example:
6617 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6618 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006619
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006620 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6621 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6622 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006623
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006624http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006625
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006626 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6627 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6628 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6629 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6630 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006631
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006632 Example:
6633 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6636 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6637 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6638 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6639 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6640 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6641 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006645 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6646 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6647 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6648 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6649 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006650
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006651http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6652 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006653
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006654 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6655 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6656 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6657 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6658 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6659 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6660 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6661 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6662 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6667 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6668 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6669 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6670 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6671 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6672 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006675
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006676 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6677 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6678 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006680http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006681
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006682 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6683 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6684 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6685 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6686 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6687 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6688 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6689 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006692
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006693 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6694 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6695 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6696 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6697 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6698 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006700 Example :
6701 # prepend the host name before the path
6702 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006703
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006704http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6705
6706 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6707 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6708 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006711
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006712 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6713 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6714 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6715 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6716 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006717
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006718http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006719
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006720 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6721 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6722 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6723 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6724 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6725 values have higher priority.
6726 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6727 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6728 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6729 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6730 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006732http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6735 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6736 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6737 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6738 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6739 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6740 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006743
6744 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006745 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6746 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6749 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6750 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6751 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006752 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6753 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006754
6755 Arguments :
6756 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6757 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006758
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006759 See also "option forwardfor".
6760
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006761 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006762 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6763 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6764
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006765 # After the masking this will track connections
6766 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6767 http-request track-sc0 src
6768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6770 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6771
6772http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6773
6774 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6775 expression.
6776
6777 Arguments:
6778 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6779 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006780
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006781 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6783 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6784
6785 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6786 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6787 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6788
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006789http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006790 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6791
6792 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6793 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6794 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6795 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6796 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6797
6798 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6799 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6800 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6801 results.
6802
6803 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006804 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6805 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6810 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6811 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6812 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6813 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6814 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6815 information from the request.
6816
6817 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6818
6819http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6822 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet33c26132022-12-02 15:22:28 +01006823 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6824 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6825 path and the query string.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006826 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6827
6828http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6829
6830 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6831 inline.
6832
6833 Arguments:
6834 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6835 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6836 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6837 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6838 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6839 (request and response)
6840 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6841 processing
6842 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6843 processing
6844 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6845 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6846 and '_'.
6847
6848 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6849 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006850
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6855 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006857 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6858 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6859 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6860 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6861 agent name must be used.
6862
6863 Arguments:
6864 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6865
6866 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6867 configuration.
6868
6869http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6870
6871 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6872 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6873 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6874 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6875 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6876 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6877 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6878 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6879 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6880 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6881 action.
6882 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6883 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6884 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6885 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6886 you fully understand how it works.
6887
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006888http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6889
6890 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6891 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6892 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6893 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6894 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006895 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006896 processing.
6897
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006898 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006899 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6900 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6901 rules evaluation.
6902
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006903http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6904http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6905 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6906 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6907 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6908 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006909
6910 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6911 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6912 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006913 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6914 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6915 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6916 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6917 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6918 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006919 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006920 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6921 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6922 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006923 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006924 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6925 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6926 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6927 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6928 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006929
6930http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6931http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6932http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6933
6934 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6935 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6936 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6937 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006938 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006939 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6940 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6941 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6942 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6943 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6944 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6945 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6946
6947 Arguments :
6948 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6949 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6950 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6951 select which table entry to update the counters.
6952
6953 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6954 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6955 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6956 that table until the session ends.
6957
6958 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6959 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6960 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6961 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6962 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6963 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6964 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6965 useful information.
6966
6967 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6968 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6969 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6970 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6971 checks that make use of it.
6972
6973http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6974
6975 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006976
6977 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006978 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006979
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006980http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6981
6982 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6983 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6984 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6985 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6986 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6987 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6988
6989 Arguments :
6990 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6991
6992 Example:
6993 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6994
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006995http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6996 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6997
6998 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6999 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7000 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7001 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7002 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7003 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7004 http-buffer-request".
7005
7006 Arguments :
7007
7008 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7009 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7010
7011 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007012 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007013 bytes.
7014
7015 Example:
7016 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7017
7018 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7019
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007020http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007022 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7023 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7024 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007025
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007028 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7029
7030 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7031 no | yes | yes | yes
7032
7033 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7034 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7035 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7036 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7037 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7038 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7041 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 Example:
7046 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007050 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7051 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007053 Example:
7054 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007058 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7059 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7062 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007064http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007066 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7067 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7068 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7069 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7070 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7071 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7072 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7073 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007075http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007076
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007077 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7078 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7079 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7080 example, or to pass some internal information.
7081 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7082 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7083 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007085http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007087 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7088 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007089
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007090http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007092 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007094http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7097 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7098 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7099 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7100 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7101 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7102 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007103
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007104 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7105 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7106 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7107 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7108 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007109
7110 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7111 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7112 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7113 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007114
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007115http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007116
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007117 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7118 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7119 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7120 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7121 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7122 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007124http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7130 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007131
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007132http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007133
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007134 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7136 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7137 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7138 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7139 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007141http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7142http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7143 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7144 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7145 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7146 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007147
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007148 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7149 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7150 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007151 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007152 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7153 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7154 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007155 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007156 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007157
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007158http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007159
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007160 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7161 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7162 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7163 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7164 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7165 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007167http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007169
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007170 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7171 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007172
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007173 Example:
7174 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007175
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007176 # applied to:
7177 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179 # outputs:
7180 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007182 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007183
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007184http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7185 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007186
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007187 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007188 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007189
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007190 Example:
7191 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007193 # applied to:
7194 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007195
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007196 # outputs:
7197 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007198
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007199http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7200 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7201 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007202 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007203 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7204
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007205 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007206 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7207 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007208 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007209 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007210 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007211 are followed to create the response :
7212
7213 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7214 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7215 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7216 ignored.
7217
7218 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7219 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007220 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007221 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7222 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223
7224 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7225 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7226 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007227 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007228 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007229
7230 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7231 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7232 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007233 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007234 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007235 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007236
7237 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7238 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7239 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7240 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7241 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7242 as a raw content.
7243
7244 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7245 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7246 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7247 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7248 considered as a raw string.
7249
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007250 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7251 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7252 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7253 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7254
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007255 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7256 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007257 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258
7259 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7260
7261 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007262 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007263 if { status eq 404 }
7264
7265 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7266 string "This is the end !" \
7267 if { status eq 500 }
7268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007269http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007271
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007272 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7273 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7274 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007275
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007276http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7277 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007278
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007279 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7280 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7281 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7282 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007283
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007284http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007286
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007287 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7288 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7289 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7290 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7291 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007292
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007293 Arguments:
7294 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7297 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007299http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007300
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007301 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7302 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7303 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007305http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7306
7307 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7308 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7309 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7310 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7311 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7312
7313http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7314
7315 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7316 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7317 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7318 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7319 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7320 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7321 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7322 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7323 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7324
7325http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7326
7327 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7328 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7329 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7330 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7331 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7332 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7333 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7334
7335http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7336
7337 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7338 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7339 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7340 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7341 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7342 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7343 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7344 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7345
7346http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7347 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7348
7349 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7350 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7351 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7352 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007353
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007354 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7356 http-response set-status 431
7357 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7358 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007359
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007360http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007361
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007362 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7363 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7364 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7365 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7366 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7367 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7368 based on some information from the request.
7369
7370 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7371
7372http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7373
7374 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7375 inline.
7376
7377 Arguments:
7378 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7379 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7380 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7381 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7382 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7383 (request and response)
7384 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7385 processing
7386 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7387 processing
7388 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7389 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7390 and '_'.
7391
7392 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7393 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007394
7395 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007396 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007397
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007398http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007399
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7401 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7402 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7403 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7404 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7405 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7406 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7407 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7408 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7409 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7410 action.
7411 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7412 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7413 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7414 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7415 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007416
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007417http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7418
7419 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7420 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7421 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7422 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7423 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007424 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007425 processing.
7426
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007427 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007428 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007429 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007430 rules evaluation.
7431
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007432http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7433http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7434http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007435
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007436 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7437 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7438 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7439 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7440 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007441 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007442
7443http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7444
7445 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7446 about <var-name>.
7447
7448 Example:
7449 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7450
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007451http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7452 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7453
7454 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7455 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7456 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7457 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7458 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7459 buffer is full.
7460
7461 Arguments :
7462
7463 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7464 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7465
7466 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007467 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007468 bytes.
7469
7470 Example:
7471 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007472
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007473http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7474 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7475
7476 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7477 yes | no | yes | yes
7478
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007479 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007480 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7481 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7482 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007483
7484 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7485
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007486 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7487 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7488 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7489 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7490 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7491 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7492 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007493 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007494 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7495 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007496
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007497 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7498 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7499 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7500 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7501 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7502 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7503 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007504 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7505 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7506 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7507 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7508 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7509 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007510
7511 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7512 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7513 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7514 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7515 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7516 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7517 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7518 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007519 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007520 downsides of rare connection failures.
7521
7522 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7523 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7524 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7525 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7526 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7527 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007528 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007529 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7530 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7531 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7532 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7533 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7534
7535 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007536 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7537 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7538 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7539 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007540
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007541 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7542 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007543
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007544 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007545
7546 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7547 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7548 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7549
Willy Tarreauee9afa22022-11-25 09:17:18 +01007550 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
7551 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
7552 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
7553 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
7554 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
7555 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
7556 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
7557 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
7558 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
7559 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
7560 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
7561
7562 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
7563 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
7564 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
7565 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
7566 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
7567
7568 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
7569 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007570
7571
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007572http-send-name-header [<header>]
7573 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007574 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7575 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007576 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007577 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7578
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007579 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7580 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7581 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7582 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7583 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7584 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7585 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7586 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7587 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7588 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7589 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7590 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7591 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7592 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7593 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7594 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007595
7596 See also : "server"
7597
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007598id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007599 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7601 no | yes | yes | yes
7602 Arguments : none
7603
7604 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7605 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7606 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007607
7608
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007609ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7610 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7611 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007612 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007613
7614 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7615 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7616 and running).
7617
7618 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7619 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7620 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007621 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007622 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7623
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007624 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7625 "unless" condition is met.
7626
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007627 Example:
7628 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7629 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7630 ignore-persist if url_static
7631
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007632 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7633
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007634load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7635 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7637 yes | no | yes | yes
7638
7639 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7640 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7641 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007642 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007643 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007644 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7645 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7646 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7647
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007648 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007650 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007651
7652 Arguments:
7653 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7654 named "server-state-file".
7655
7656 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7657 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7658 name is used as a file name.
7659
7660 none don't load any stat for this backend
7661
7662 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007663 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7664 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7665 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007666 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007667 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007668
7669 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7670 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7671
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007672 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007673
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007674 global
7675 stats socket /tmp/socket
7676 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007677
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007678 defaults
7679 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007681 backend bk
7682 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7683 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007684
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007685
7686 Then one can run :
7687
7688 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7689
7690 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7691
7692 1
7693 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7694 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7695 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7696
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007697 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007698
7699 global
7700 stats socket /tmp/socket
7701 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7702
7703 defaults
7704 load-server-state-from-file local
7705
7706 backend bk
7707 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7708 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7709
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007710
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007711 Then one can run :
7712
7713 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7714
7715 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7716
7717 1
7718 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7719 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7720 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7721
7722 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7723 "show servers state"
7724
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007726log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007728 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007729no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007730 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7732 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007733
7734 Prefix :
7735 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7736 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7737 prefix does not allow arguments.
7738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007739 Arguments :
7740 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7741 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7742 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7743 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7744 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7745 parameter.
7746
7747 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7748 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7749
7750 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7751 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7752 standard syslog port).
7753
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007754 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7755 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7756 standard syslog port).
7757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007758 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7759 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7760 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007761 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007762
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007763 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7764 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7765 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7766 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7767 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7768 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7769 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7770 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7771 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7772 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7773 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7774 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007775 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007776 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7777 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7778 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007779 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7780 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007781
7782 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7783 and "fd@2", see above.
7784
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007785 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7786 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7787 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7788 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7789 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7790 having the logs instantly available.
7791
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007792 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7793 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7794 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7795
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007796 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7797 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007798
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007799 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7800 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7801 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7802 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7803 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7804 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7805 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7806 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7807 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7808 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007809 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007810
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007811 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7812 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7813 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7814 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7815 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7816
7817 <sample_size>
7818 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7819 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7820 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7821 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7822 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7823
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007824 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7825 one of the following :
7826
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007827 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7828 field is stripped. This is the default.
7829 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7830 rfc3164.
7831
7832 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007833 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7834
7835 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7836 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7837
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007838 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7839 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7840 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7841 designed to be used with a local log server.
7842
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007843 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7844 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7845 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7846 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7847 systemd logger consumes.
7848
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007849 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7850 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7851 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7852 used with a local log server.
7853
7854 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7855 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7856 designed to be used with a local log server.
7857
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007858 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7859 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7860 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7861 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7862
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007863 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7864
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007865 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7866 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7867 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7868
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007869 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7870 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7871 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7872 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007873
7874 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7875 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7876 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007877 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7878 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7879 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7880 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7881 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007882
7883 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7884
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007885 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7886 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7887 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007888
7889 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7890 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7891 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7892 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7893
7894 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7895 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007896
7897 Example :
7898 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007899 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7900 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7901 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007902 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007903 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7904 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007905 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007906
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007907
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007908log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007909 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7911 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007912
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007913 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7914 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7915 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7916 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7917 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007918
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007919 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7920 "option httplog" directives.
7921
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007922log-format-sd <string>
7923 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7924 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7925 yes | yes | yes | no
7926
7927 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7928 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7929 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7930 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7931 which covers the log format string in depth.
7932
7933 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7934 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7935
7936 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7937 log format to "rfc5424".
7938
7939 Example :
7940 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7941
7942
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007943log-tag <string>
7944 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7946 yes | yes | yes | yes
7947
7948 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7949 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007950 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007951 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7952 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7953 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7954 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7955 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7956 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007957
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007958max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7959 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7960 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7961 yes | no | yes | yes
7962
7963 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7964 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7965 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7966 servers.
7967
7968 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007969 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007970 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7971 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7972 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007973 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007974 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7975 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7976 picking a different server.
7977
7978 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7979 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7980 even if they have to be queued.
7981
7982 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7983 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7984
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007985max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7986 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7987 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7988 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007989
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007990maxconn <conns>
7991 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 yes | yes | yes | no
7994 Arguments :
7995 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7996 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7997 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7998 closes.
7999
8000 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008001 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008002 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8003 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008004 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8005 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8006 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8007 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
8009 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8010 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8011 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8012
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008013 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8014 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008015
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8017
8018
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008019mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008020 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8022 yes | yes | yes | yes
8023 Arguments :
8024 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8025 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8026 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8027 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8028
8029 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8030 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8031 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8032 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8033 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008035 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8036 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8037 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008038
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008039 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008040 defaults http_instances
8041 mode http
8042
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008043
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008044monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008045 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8047 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008048 Arguments :
8049 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8050 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008051 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008052 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8053 backend and its backup.
8054
8055 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8056 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8057 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8058 servers in a list of backends.
8059
8060 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8061 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8062 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008063 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008064 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8065 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008066 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008067 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8068 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008069
8070 Example:
8071 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008072 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008073 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8074 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8075 monitor-uri /site_alive
8076 monitor fail if site_dead
8077
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008078 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008079
8080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008081monitor-uri <uri>
8082 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8084 yes | yes | yes | no
8085 Arguments :
8086 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8087 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8088
8089 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8090 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8091 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8092 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8093 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8094 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8095 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8096 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8097
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008098 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008099 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8100 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau28848542022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008101 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8102 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8103 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008104 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8105 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8106 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008107
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008108 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8109 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8110 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8111 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8112
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008113 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008114 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008115 frontend www
8116 mode http
8117 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8118
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008119 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008120
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008121
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008122option abortonclose
8123no option abortonclose
8124 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8126 yes | no | yes | yes
8127 Arguments : none
8128
8129 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8130 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8131 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8132 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008133 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008134 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8135 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8136 encountered while delivering the response.
8137
8138 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8139 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8140 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8141 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8142 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8143 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008144 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008145 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008146 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008147 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8148 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8149 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008151 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8152 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008153 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8154 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8155 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8156 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8157 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8158 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008159 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008160
8161 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8162 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8163
8164 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8165
8166
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008167option accept-invalid-http-request
8168no option accept-invalid-http-request
8169 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8171 yes | yes | yes | no
8172 Arguments : none
8173
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008174 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008175 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008176 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008177 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8178 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8179 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8180 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8181 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008182 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8183 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8184 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8185 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008186 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008187 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008188 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8189 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8190 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008191
8192 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8193 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8194 been confirmed.
8195
8196 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8197 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008198 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8199 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008200 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8201
8202 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8203 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8204
8205 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8206 stats socket.
8207
8208
8209option accept-invalid-http-response
8210no option accept-invalid-http-response
8211 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8213 yes | no | yes | yes
8214 Arguments : none
8215
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008216 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008217 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008218 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008219 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8220 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8221 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8222 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8223 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008224 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8225 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8226 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008227
8228 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8229 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8230 been confirmed.
8231
8232 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8233 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8234 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8235 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8236
8237 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8238 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8239
8240 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8241 stats socket.
8242
8243
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008244option allbackups
8245no option allbackups
8246 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8248 yes | no | yes | yes
8249 Arguments : none
8250
8251 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8252 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8253 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8254 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8255 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8256 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8257 order between the backup servers anymore.
8258
8259 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8260 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8261
8262 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8263 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8264
8265
8266option checkcache
8267no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008268 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008269 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8270 yes | no | yes | yes
8271 Arguments : none
8272
8273 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8274 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008275 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008276 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8277 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008278 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008279
8280 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008281 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008282 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008283 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8284 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008285 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008287 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8288 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008289 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008290 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8291 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008292 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008293 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8294 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8295 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8296 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8297 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8298 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8299 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8300 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8301 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8302
8303 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008304 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8305 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8306 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8307 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008308
8309 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8310 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008311 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008312 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008313
8314 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8315 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8316
8317
8318option clitcpka
8319no option clitcpka
8320 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8322 yes | yes | yes | no
8323 Arguments : none
8324
8325 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8326 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008327 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008328 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8329
8330 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8331 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8332 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8333 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8334
8335 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8336 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8337 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8338 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8339 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8340
8341 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8342
8343 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8344 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8345 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8346
8347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8349
8350 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8351
8352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008353option contstats
8354 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8356 yes | yes | yes | no
8357 Arguments : none
8358
8359 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8360 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8361 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008362 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008363 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8364 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8365 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8366 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8367 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008368
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008369option disable-h2-upgrade
8370no option disable-h2-upgrade
8371 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8372 connection.
8373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8374 yes | yes | yes | no
8375 Arguments : none
8376
8377 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8378 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8379 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8380 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008381 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8382 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8383 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8384 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8385 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8386 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008387
8388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008390
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008391option dontlog-normal
8392no option dontlog-normal
8393 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 yes | yes | yes | no
8396 Arguments : none
8397
8398 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8399 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8400 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8401 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8402 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8403 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8404 logged.
8405
8406 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8407 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8408 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008410 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008411 logging.
8412
8413
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008414option dontlognull
8415no option dontlognull
8416 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8418 yes | yes | yes | no
8419 Arguments : none
8420
8421 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8422 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8423 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8424 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8425 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8426 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008427 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8428 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8429 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008430
8431 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008432 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008433 would not be logged.
8434
8435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8437
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008438 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008439 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008440
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008441
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008442option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008443 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8445 yes | yes | yes | yes
8446 Arguments :
8447 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8448 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008449 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008450 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008451
8452 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8453 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8454 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8455 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8456 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8457 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8458 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008459 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8460 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8461 possible that the client has already brought one.
8462
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008463 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008464 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008465 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008466 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008467 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008468 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008469
8470 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8471 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8472 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8473 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8474 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8475 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008476 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008477
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008478 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8479 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008480 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008481 are under the control of the end-user.
8482
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008483 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008484 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8485 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008486 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8487 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8488 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008489
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008490 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008491 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8492 frontend www
8493 mode http
8494 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8495
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008496 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8497 backend www
8498 mode http
8499 option forwardfor header X-Client
8500
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008501 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008502 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008503
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008504
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008505option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8506no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8507 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8509 yes | yes | yes | no
8510 Arguments : none
8511
8512 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8513 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8514 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8515 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8516 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8517 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8518 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8519
8520 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8521 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8522 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8523 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8524 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8525 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8526 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8527 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8528 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8529 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8530
8531 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8532
8533 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8534 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8535
8536 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8537 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8538
8539
8540option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8541no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8542 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8544 yes | no | yes | yes
8545 Arguments : none
8546
8547 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8548 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8549 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8550 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8551 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8552 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8553 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8554
8555 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8556 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8557 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8558 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8559 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8560 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8561 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8562 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8563 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8564 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8565
8566 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8567
8568 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8569 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8570
8571 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8572 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8573
8574
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008575option http-buffer-request
8576no option http-buffer-request
8577 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8579 yes | yes | yes | yes
8580 Arguments : none
8581
8582 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8583 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8584 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8585 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8586 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8587 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008588 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8589 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8590 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8591 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008592
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008593 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8594 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008595
8596
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008597option http-ignore-probes
8598no option http-ignore-probes
8599 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8601 yes | yes | yes | no
8602 Arguments : none
8603
8604 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8605 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8606 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8607 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8608 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8609 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8610 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8611 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8612 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008613 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8614 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008615 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8616
8617 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8618 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8619 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8620 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8621 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8622 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8623 are often the only way to detect them.
8624
8625 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8626 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8627
8628 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8629
8630
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008631option http-keep-alive
8632no option http-keep-alive
8633 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8635 yes | yes | yes | yes
8636 Arguments : none
8637
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008638 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8639 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008640 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8641 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008642 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8643 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8644 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008645
8646 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8647 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008648 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8649 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8650 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8651 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8652 situations where this option may be useful :
8653
8654 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008655 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008656
8657 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8658 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8659
8660 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8661 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8662 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8663 request.
8664
8665 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8666 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008667 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8668 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8669 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008670
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008671 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8672 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8673 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8674 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8675 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8676 not set.
8677
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008678 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8679 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8680 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008681
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008682 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008683 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008684 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008685
8686
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008687option http-no-delay
8688no option http-no-delay
8689 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8691 yes | yes | yes | yes
8692 Arguments : none
8693
8694 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8695 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8696 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8697 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8698 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8699 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8700 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008701 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008702 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8703 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8704 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8705 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8706 affected.
8707
8708 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8709 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8710 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8711 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8712 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8713 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8714 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8715 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8716 latency environments.
8717
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008718 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8719
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008720
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008721option http-pretend-keepalive
8722no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008723 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008726 Arguments : none
8727
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008728 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008729 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8730 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8731 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008732 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008733 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8734 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8735 consider the response complete.
8736
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008737 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008739 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008740 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008741 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008742 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8743
8744 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8745 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8746 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8747 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008748 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8749 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008750 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8751
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008752 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8753 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8754 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8755 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8756 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8757 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008758
8759 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8760 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8761
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008762 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008763 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008764
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008765option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8766 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8767 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8769 yes | yes | yes | yes
8770 Arguments :
8771 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8772 with no FastCGI application configured.
8773
8774 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8775 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8776 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8777
8778 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8779 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8780
8781 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8782 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8783 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8784 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8785 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8786 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8787 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8788 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8789
8790 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8791 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008792
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008793option http-server-close
8794no option http-server-close
8795 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8797 yes | yes | yes | yes
8798 Arguments : none
8799
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008800 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8801 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8802 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8803 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008804 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8805 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8806 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8807 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8808 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8809 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8810 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8811 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8812 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8813 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8814 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008815
8816 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8817 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8818 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8819 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008820 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8821 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008822
8823 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8824 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008825 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8826 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8827 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008828
8829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8831
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008832 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8833 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008834
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008835option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008836no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008837 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8839 yes | yes | yes | no
8840 Arguments : none
8841
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008842 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008843 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8844 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8845 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8846 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8847 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008848 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008849
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008850 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008851 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008852 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8853 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8854 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008855
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008856 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8857 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8858 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8859 front of an existing proxy.
8860
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008861 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8862
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008863 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008865option httpchk
8866option httpchk <uri>
8867option httpchk <method> <uri>
8868option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008869 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8871 yes | no | yes | yes
8872 Arguments :
8873 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8874 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8875 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8876 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8877 ones.
8878
8879 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8880 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8881 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8882
8883 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8884 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8885 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008886 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008887
8888 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8889 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8890 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8891 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8892 the lack of any response.
8893
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008894 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8895 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8896 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8897 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8898
8899 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8900 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8901 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008902
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008903 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8904 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008905 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008906 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008907 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008908
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008909 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8910 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8911 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8912 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8913
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008914 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008915 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8916 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8917 backend https_relay
8918 mode tcp
8919 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8920 http-check send hdr Host www
8921 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008922
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008923 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8924 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8925 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008926
8927
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008928option httpclose
8929no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008930 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8932 yes | yes | yes | yes
8933 Arguments : none
8934
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008935 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8936 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8937 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8938 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008939 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008940
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008941 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8942 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008943 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008944 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8945 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008946
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008947 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8948 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8949 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008950
8951 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8952 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008953 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8954 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8955 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008956
8957 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8958 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8959
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008960 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008961
8962
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008963option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008964 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008966 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008967 Arguments :
8968 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8969 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8970 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008971 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008972 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008973
8974 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8975 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8976 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8977 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8978 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8979 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8980 ports.
8981
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008982 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8983 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008984
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008985 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008987 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008988
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008989
8990option http_proxy
8991no option http_proxy
8992 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8994 yes | yes | yes | yes
8995 Arguments : none
8996
8997 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8998 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8999 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
9000 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
9001 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
9002
9003 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
9004 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009005 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
9006 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009007
9008 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9009 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9010
9011 Example :
9012 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
9013 backend direct_forward
9014 option httpclose
9015 option http_proxy
9016
9017 See also : "option httpclose"
9018
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009019
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009020option independent-streams
9021no option independent-streams
9022 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9024 yes | yes | yes | yes
9025 Arguments : none
9026
9027 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9028 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9029 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9030 receive data or not.
9031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009032 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009033 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9034 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9035 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9036 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9037 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9038 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9039 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9040 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9041 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9042 socket buffers.
9043
9044 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9045 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9046 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9047 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9048 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9049
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009050 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009051
9052
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009053option ldap-check
9054 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | no | yes | yes
9057 Arguments : none
9058
9059 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9060 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9061 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9062 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9063
9064 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9065 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9066
9067 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9068 configure it.
9069
9070 Example :
9071 option ldap-check
9072
9073 See also : "option httpchk"
9074
9075
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009076option external-check
9077 Use external processes for server health checks
9078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9079 yes | no | yes | yes
9080
9081 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9082 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9083 command".
9084
9085 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9086
9087 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9088
9089
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009090option idle-close-on-response
9091no option idle-close-on-response
9092 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9094 yes | yes | yes | no
9095 Arguments : none
9096
9097 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9098 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9099 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9100 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9101 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9102 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9103 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9104 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9105 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9106
9107 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9108 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9109
9110 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9111 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9112 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9113 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9114
9115 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9116 "hard-stop-after"
9117
9118
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009119option log-health-checks
9120no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009121 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9123 yes | no | yes | yes
9124 Arguments : none
9125
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009126 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9127 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9128 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009129
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009130 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9131 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9132 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9133 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9134 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9135
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009136 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009137 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009138
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009139 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9140 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9141 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009142
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009143
9144option log-separate-errors
9145no option log-separate-errors
9146 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 yes | yes | yes | no
9149 Arguments : none
9150
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009151 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009152 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9153 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9154 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9155 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9156 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9157 provides very important information.
9158
9159 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9160 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9161 error logs.
9162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009163 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009164 logging.
9165
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009166
9167option logasap
9168no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009169 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9171 yes | yes | yes | no
9172 Arguments : none
9173
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009174 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9175 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9176 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9177 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9178
9179 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9180 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9181 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9182 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9183 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009184 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009185 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9186 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9187 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9188 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009189 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009190
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009191 Examples :
9192 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9193 mode http
9194 option httplog
9195 option logasap
9196 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9197
9198 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9199 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9200 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9201 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9202
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009203 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009204 logging.
9205
9206
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009207option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009208 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009211 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009212 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9213 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009214 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9215 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009216
9217 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9218 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009219 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009220 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009221 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9222 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9223 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009224
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009225 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9226 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9227 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009228
9229 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009230 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009231 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9232 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9233 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9234 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9235 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9236 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9237 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9238
9239 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9240 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009241
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009242 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009243
9244 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9245 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9246 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9247 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009248 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009249 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009250
9251 See also: "option httpchk"
9252
9253
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009254option nolinger
9255no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009256 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009257 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9258 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009259 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009260
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009262 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9263 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9264 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9265 connections.
9266
9267 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9268 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009269 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9270 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9271 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9272 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9273 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9274 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9275 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9276 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9277 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9278 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9279 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9280 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9281 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009282
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009283 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9284 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9285 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9286 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9287 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009288
9289 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9290 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009291 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009292 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009293 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009294
9295 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9296 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9297
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009298 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9299 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009300
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009301option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9302 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9304 yes | yes | yes | yes
9305 Arguments :
9306 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9307 matching <network>
9308 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9309 header name.
9310
9311 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9312 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9313 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9314 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9315 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9316 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9317 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9318 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9319 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9320 possible that the client has already brought one.
9321
9322 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9323 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9324 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9325 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9326 header and requires different one.
9327
9328 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9329 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9330 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009331 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9332 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9333 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9334 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9335 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009336
9337 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9338 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9339 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9340 both are defined.
9341
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009342 Examples :
9343 # Original Destination address
9344 frontend www
9345 mode http
9346 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9347
9348 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9349 backend www
9350 mode http
9351 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9352
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009353 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009354
9355
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009356option persist
9357no option persist
9358 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9359 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9360 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009361 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009362
9363 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9364 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9365 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9366 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9367 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9368 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9369 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9370 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9371 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9372 redirected to another valid server.
9373
9374 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9375 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9376
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009377 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009378
9379
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009380option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009381 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9383 yes | no | yes | yes
9384 Arguments :
9385 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9386 PostgreSQL server.
9387
9388 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9389 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9390 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9391 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9392
9393 See also: "option httpchk"
9394
9395
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009396option prefer-last-server
9397no option prefer-last-server
9398 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9400 yes | no | yes | yes
9401 Arguments : none
9402
9403 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009404 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009405 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9406 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009407 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009408 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009409 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009410 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9411 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009412 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009413 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009414 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9415 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9416 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009417 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9418 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9419 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009420
9421 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9422 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9423
9424 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9425
9426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009427option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009428option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009429no option redispatch
9430 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9431 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9432 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009433 Arguments :
9434 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9435 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9436 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009437 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009438 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009439 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009440 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9441 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9442 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9443
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009444
9445 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9446 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9447 be able to access the service anymore.
9448
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009449 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9450 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009451
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009452 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9453 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9454 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9455 following order:
9456
9457 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9458
9459 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9460 list, or
9461
9462 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9463
9464 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9465 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9466
9467 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9468 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9469 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9470 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9471
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009472 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009473 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9474 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9478
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009479 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009480
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009481
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009482option redis-check
9483 Use redis health checks for server testing
9484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9485 yes | no | yes | yes
9486 Arguments : none
9487
9488 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9489 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9490 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9491 find the "+PONG" response message.
9492
9493 Example :
9494 option redis-check
9495
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009496 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009497
9498
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009499option smtpchk
9500option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9501 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9502 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9503 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009504 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009505 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009506 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009507 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9508
9509 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9510 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9511 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9512
9513 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9514 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9515 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9516 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9517 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9518 dead server.
9519
9520 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9521 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009522 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009523 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9524
9525 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9526 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9527 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9528 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009529 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009530
9531 Example :
9532 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9533
9534 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9535
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009536
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009537option socket-stats
9538no option socket-stats
9539
9540 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9541 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9542 yes | yes | yes | no
9543
9544 Arguments : none
9545
9546
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009547option splice-auto
9548no option splice-auto
9549 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9551 yes | yes | yes | yes
9552 Arguments : none
9553
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009554 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009555 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009556 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009557 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009558 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009559 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9560 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9561 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9562 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9563
9564 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9565 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9566 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9567 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9568 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9569 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9570 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9571 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9572 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9573 keyword.
9574
9575 Example :
9576 option splice-auto
9577
9578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9580
9581 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9582 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9583
9584
9585option splice-request
9586no option splice-request
9587 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9589 yes | yes | yes | yes
9590 Arguments : none
9591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009592 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009593 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009594 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9595 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9596 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9597 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9598
9599 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9600
9601 Example :
9602 option splice-request
9603
9604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9606
9607 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9608 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9609
9610
9611option splice-response
9612no option splice-response
9613 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | yes | yes | yes
9616 Arguments : none
9617
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009618 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009619 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009620 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9621 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9622 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9623 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9624
9625 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9626
9627 Example :
9628 option splice-response
9629
9630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9632
9633 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9634 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9635
9636
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009637option spop-check
9638 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9640 no | no | no | yes
9641 Arguments : none
9642
9643 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9644 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9645 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9646 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9647
9648 Example :
9649 option spop-check
9650
9651 See also : "option httpchk"
9652
9653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009654option srvtcpka
9655no option srvtcpka
9656 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9658 yes | no | yes | yes
9659 Arguments : none
9660
9661 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9662 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009663 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009664 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9665
9666 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9667 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9668 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9669 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9670
9671 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9672 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9673 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9674 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9675 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9676
9677 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9678
9679 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9680 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9681 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9682
9683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9685
9686 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9687
9688
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009689option ssl-hello-chk
9690 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 yes | no | yes | yes
9693 Arguments : none
9694
9695 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9696 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9697 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9698 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9699 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9700 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9701 hello message.
9702
9703 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9704 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9705 messages, which is appreciable.
9706
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009707 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009708 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9709 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009710
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009711 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9712
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009713
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009714option tcp-check
9715 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9717 yes | no | yes | yes
9718
9719 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9720 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9721
9722 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9723 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9724 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9725
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009726 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009727 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9728 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9729 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9730 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9731 only.
9732
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009733 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009734 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009735 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9736 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9737 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9738
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009739 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009740 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9741 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009742 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009743 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9744 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9745 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9746 the respective protocols.
9747 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009748 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009750 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009751
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009752 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9753 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9754 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9755 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009756
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009757 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9758 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9759 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009760
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009761
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009762 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009763 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009764 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009765 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009766
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009767 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009768 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009769 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009770
9771 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9772 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009773 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009774 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009775 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009776 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009777 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009778 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009779 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9780 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009781 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009782 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9783 tcp-check expect string +OK
9784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009785 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009786 (send many headers before analyzing)
9787 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009788 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009789 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9790 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9791 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9792 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009793 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009794
9795
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009796 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009797
9798
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009799option tcp-smart-accept
9800no option tcp-smart-accept
9801 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9803 yes | yes | yes | no
9804 Arguments : none
9805
9806 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9807 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9808 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9809 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9810 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9811 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9812
9813 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9814 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9815 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9816 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9817
9818 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9819 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9820 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009821 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009822
9823 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9824 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9825 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9826
9827 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9828 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9829 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9830
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009831 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9832
9833
9834option tcp-smart-connect
9835no option tcp-smart-connect
9836 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9838 yes | no | yes | yes
9839 Arguments : none
9840
9841 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9842 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9843 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9844 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9845 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9846
9847 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9848 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9849 complex.
9850
9851 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9852 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9853 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9854
9855 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9856 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9857
9858 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9859
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009860
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009861option tcpka
9862 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9864 yes | yes | yes | yes
9865 Arguments : none
9866
9867 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9868 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009869 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009870 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9871
9872 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9873 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9874 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9875 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9876
9877 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9878 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9879 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9880 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9881 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9882
9883 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9884
9885 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9886 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9887 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9888 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9889 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9890 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9891 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9892 backends.
9893
9894 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9895
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896
9897option tcplog
9898 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009900 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901 Arguments : none
9902
9903 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9904 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9905 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9906 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9907 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9908 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9909 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9910 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9911
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009912 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009914 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009915
9916
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009917option transparent
9918no option transparent
9919 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009921 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009922 Arguments : none
9923
9924 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9925 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9926 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9927 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9928 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9929 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9930 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9931 appropriate server.
9932
9933 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9934 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9935
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009936 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009937 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009938
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009939
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009940external-check command <command>
9941 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9943 yes | no | yes | yes
9944
9945 Arguments :
9946 <command> is the external command to run
9947
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009948 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9949
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009950 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009951
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009952 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9953 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9954 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9955 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9956 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9957 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009958
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009959 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9960
9961 Environment variables :
9962 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9963 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9964
9965 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9966
9967 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9968
9969 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9970 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9971 for a UNIX socket).
9972
9973 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9974
9975 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9976
9977 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9978
9979 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9980
9981 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9982
9983 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9984 socket).
9985
9986 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9987 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9988
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009989 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9990
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009991 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9992 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9993 failed.
9994
9995 Example :
9996 external-check command /bin/true
9997
9998 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9999
10000
10001external-check path <path>
10002 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10004 yes | no | yes | yes
10005
10006 Arguments :
10007 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10008
10009 The default path is "".
10010
10011 Example :
10012 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10013
10014 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10015 "external-check command"
10016
10017
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010018persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010019persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010020 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 yes | no | yes | yes
10023 Arguments :
10024 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010025 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10026 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010027
10028 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10029 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010030 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010031 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10032 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10033 forwarded to this server.
10034
10035 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10036 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10037 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010038 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010039 a single "listen" section.
10040
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010041 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10042 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10043 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10044
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010045 Example :
10046 listen tse-farm
10047 bind :3389
10048 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10049 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10050 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10051 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10052 persist rdp-cookie
10053 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010054 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010055 balance rdp-cookie
10056 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10057 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10058
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010059 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010060
10061
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010062rate-limit sessions <rate>
10063 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10065 yes | yes | yes | no
10066 Arguments :
10067 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10068 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10069
10070 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10071 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10072 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010073 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010074 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10075 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10076
10077 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10078 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10079 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10080 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10081
10082 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10083 listen smtp
10084 mode tcp
10085 bind :25
10086 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010087 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010088
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010089 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10090 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10091 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010092
10093 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10094
10095
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010096redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10097redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10098redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010099 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10101 no | yes | yes | yes
10102
10103 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010104 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010105
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010106 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010107 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010108 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10109 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10110 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010111
10112 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10113 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10114 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10115 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10116 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010117 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10118 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10119 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10120 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010121
10122 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10123 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10124 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10125 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10126 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10127 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010128 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010129 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010130 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10131 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10132 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010133
10134 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010135 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10136 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10137 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010138 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010139 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10140 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10141 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10142 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010143
10144 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010145 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010146
10147 - "drop-query"
10148 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10149 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10150 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10151 with a location-type redirect.
10152
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010153 - "append-slash"
10154 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10155 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10156 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10157 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10158
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010159 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10160 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10161 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10162 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10163 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10164 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10165 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10166
10167 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10168 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10169 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10170 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10171 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10172 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10173 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010174
10175 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10176 acl clear dst_port 80
10177 acl secure dst_port 8080
10178 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010179 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010180 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010181 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10182
10183 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010184 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10185 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10186 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010187 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010188
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010189 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10190 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10191 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10192
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010193 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010194 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010195
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010196 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010197 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10198 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10199 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010200
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010201 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010202
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010203
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010204retries <value>
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010205 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010206 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10207 yes | no | yes | yes
10208 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010209 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10210 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010211
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010212 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10213 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10214 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10215 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10216 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010217
10218 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010219 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010220 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010221
Willy Tarreaucc834882022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010222 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10223 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10224 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010225
10226 See also : "option redispatch"
10227
10228
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010229retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010230 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10231 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10232 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10234 yes | no | yes | yes
10235 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010236 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10237 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10238 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10239 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10240 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010241
10242 none never retry
10243
10244 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10245 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10246
10247 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10248 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10249 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10250 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10251 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10252 processing the request.
10253
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010254 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10255 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10256 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10257 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10258 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10259 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10260 overflow attack for example).
10261
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010262 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10263 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10264 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10265 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10266 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10267 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10268 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10269 amplify denial of service attacks.
10270
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010271 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10272 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10273 considered to be safe to retry.
10274
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010275 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10276 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10277 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10278 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10279 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010280
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010281 all-retryable-errors
10282 retry request for any error that are considered
10283 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10284 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10285 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10286
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010287 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10288 not cumulative.
10289
10290 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10291 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10292 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10293 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10294
10295 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10296 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10297 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10298 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10299 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10300 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10301 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10302 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10303 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10304 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10305 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10306 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10307
10308 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10309 should not use this directive.
10310
10311 The default is "conn-failure".
10312
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010313 Example:
10314 retry-on 503 504
10315
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010316 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10317
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010318server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319 Declare a server in a backend
10320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10321 no | no | yes | yes
10322 Arguments :
10323 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010324 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010325 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010327 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10328 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10329 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10330 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010331 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10332 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010333 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010334 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10335 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010336 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10337 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10338 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10339 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10340 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10341 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10342 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010343 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010344 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10345 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10346 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10347 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10348 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10349 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010350 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10351 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010352 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10353 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010355 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010356 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10357 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10358 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10359 adding this value to the client's port.
10360
10361 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10362 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010363 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010364
10365 Examples :
10366 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10367 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010368 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010369 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10370 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10371 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010372
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010373 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10374 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10375 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10376 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10377 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10378
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010379 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10380 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010381
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010382server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010383 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010384 this backend.
10385 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10386 no | no | yes | yes
10387
10388 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10389 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10390 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10391 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10392 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010393
10394 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10395 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10396
10397 global
10398 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10399
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010400 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010401 load-server-state-from-file
10402
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010403 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010404 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010405
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010406server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10407 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10408 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10410 no | no | yes | yes
10411
10412 Arguments:
10413 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10414
10415 <num | range>
10416 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10417 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10418 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10419 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10420
10421 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10422
10423 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10424
10425 <params*>
10426 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10427 keyword.
10428
10429 Examples:
10430 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10431 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10432 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10433
10434 # or
10435 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10436
10437 # would be equivalent to:
10438 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10439 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10440 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10441
10442
10443
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010444source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010445source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010446source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010447 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10449 yes | no | yes | yes
10450 Arguments :
10451 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10452 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010453
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010454 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010455 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10456 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10457 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10458 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10459 supported prefixes are :
10460 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10461 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10462 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010463 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010464 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10465 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010466
10467 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10468 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010469 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10470 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10471 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010472
10473 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10474 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10475 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10476 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10477 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10478 <addr>.
10479
10480 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10481 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10482 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10483 port.
10484
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010485 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10486 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10487 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10488 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010489 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010490 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10491 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10492 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10493 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10494 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10495 HTTP header.
10496
10497 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10498 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010499 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010500 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10501 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10502 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10503 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10504 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10505 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10506 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10507
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010508 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10509 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10510 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10511 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10512 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10513 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10514
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010515 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10516 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10517 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10518 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10519
10520 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10521 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10522 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10523 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10524 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10525 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10526
10527 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10528 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10529 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10530 there are two methods :
10531
10532 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10533 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10534 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10535 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10536 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10537 of the client ranges may be used.
10538
10539 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10540 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10541 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10542 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10543 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10544 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10545 same session.
10546
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010547 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10548 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10549 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010550 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010551
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010552 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10553
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010554 Examples :
10555 backend private
10556 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10557 source 192.168.1.200
10558
10559 backend transparent_ssl1
10560 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10561 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10562
10563 backend transparent_ssl2
10564 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10565 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10566 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10567
10568 backend transparent_ssl3
10569 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10570 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10571 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10572
10573 backend transparent_smtp
10574 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10575 # with Tproxy version 4.
10576 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10577
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010578 backend transparent_http
10579 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10580 # proxy.
10581 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010583 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010584 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10585
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010586
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010587srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10588 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10589 the connection on the server side.
10590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10591 yes | no | yes | yes
10592 Arguments :
10593 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10594
10595 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10596 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010597 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10598 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010599
10600 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10601
10602
10603srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10604 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10605 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10606 server side.
10607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10608 yes | no | yes | yes
10609 Arguments :
10610 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10611 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10612 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10613 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10614
10615 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10616 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010617 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10618 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010619
10620 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10621
10622
10623srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10624 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10626 yes | no | yes | yes
10627 Arguments :
10628 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10629 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10630 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10631 document.
10632
10633 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10634 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010635 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10636 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010637
10638 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10639
10640
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010641stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10642 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010644 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010645
10646 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10647 matched.
10648
10649 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10650 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10651
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010652 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10653 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010654 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010655
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010656 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10657 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10658 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10659 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010660
10661 Example :
10662 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10663 backend stats_localhost
10664 stats enable
10665 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10666
10667 Example :
10668 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10669 backend stats_auth
10670 stats enable
10671 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10672 stats admin if TRUE
10673
10674 Example :
10675 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10676 userlist stats-auth
10677 group admin users admin
10678 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10679 group readonly users haproxy
10680 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10681
10682 backend stats_auth
10683 stats enable
10684 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10685 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10686 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10687 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10688
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010689 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10690 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10691 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010692
10693
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10695 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10696 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010697 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010698 Arguments :
10699 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10700
10701 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10702
10703 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10704 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10705 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10706 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10707 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10708 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10709
10710 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10711 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10712 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010713 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010714
10715 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10716 report using "stats scope".
10717
10718 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10719 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10720 unobvious parameters.
10721
10722 Example :
10723 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10724 backend public_www
10725 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10726 stats enable
10727 stats hide-version
10728 stats scope .
10729 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010730 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010731 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10732 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10733
10734 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10735 backend private_monitoring
10736 stats enable
10737 stats uri /admin?stats
10738 stats refresh 5s
10739
10740 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10741
10742
10743stats enable
10744 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010746 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010747 Arguments : none
10748
10749 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10750 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10751 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10752 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10753 - stats auth : no authentication
10754 - stats scope : no restriction
10755
10756 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10757 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10758 unobvious parameters.
10759
10760 Example :
10761 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10762 backend public_www
10763 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10764 stats enable
10765 stats hide-version
10766 stats scope .
10767 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010768 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010769 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10770 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10771
10772 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10773 backend private_monitoring
10774 stats enable
10775 stats uri /admin?stats
10776 stats refresh 5s
10777
10778 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10779
10780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010781stats hide-version
10782 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010783 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010784 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010785 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010787 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10788 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10789 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10790 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10791 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10792 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010794 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10795 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10796 unobvious parameters.
10797
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010798 Example :
10799 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10800 backend public_www
10801 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010802 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803 stats hide-version
10804 stats scope .
10805 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010807 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10808 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010809
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010810 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10811 backend private_monitoring
10812 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010813 stats uri /admin?stats
10814 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010815
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010816 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010817
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010818
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010819stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10821 Access control for statistics
10822
10823 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10824 no | no | yes | yes
10825
10826 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10827 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10828 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10829 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10830 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10831 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10832
10833 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10834 instance.
10835
10836 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10837 about ACL usage.
10838
10839
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010840stats realm <realm>
10841 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010843 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010844 Arguments :
10845 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10846 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10847 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10848
10849 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10850 using a backslash ('\').
10851
10852 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10853 only related to authentication.
10854
10855 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10856 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10857 unobvious parameters.
10858
10859 Example :
10860 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10861 backend public_www
10862 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10863 stats enable
10864 stats hide-version
10865 stats scope .
10866 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010867 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010868 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10869 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10870
10871 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10872 backend private_monitoring
10873 stats enable
10874 stats uri /admin?stats
10875 stats refresh 5s
10876
10877 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10878
10879
10880stats refresh <delay>
10881 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010884 Arguments :
10885 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10886 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10887 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10888 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10889 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10890 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10891
10892 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10893 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10894 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010895 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010896
10897 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10898 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10899 unobvious parameters.
10900
10901 Example :
10902 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10903 backend public_www
10904 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10905 stats enable
10906 stats hide-version
10907 stats scope .
10908 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010909 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010910 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10911 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10912
10913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10914 backend private_monitoring
10915 stats enable
10916 stats uri /admin?stats
10917 stats refresh 5s
10918
10919 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10920
10921
10922stats scope { <name> | "." }
10923 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010925 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010926 Arguments :
10927 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10928 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10929 section in which the statement appears.
10930
10931 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10932 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10933 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10934 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10935 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10936 exists.
10937
10938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10940 unobvious parameters.
10941
10942 Example :
10943 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10944 backend public_www
10945 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10946 stats enable
10947 stats hide-version
10948 stats scope .
10949 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010950 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010951 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10952 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10953
10954 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10955 backend private_monitoring
10956 stats enable
10957 stats uri /admin?stats
10958 stats refresh 5s
10959
10960 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10961
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010962
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010963stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010964 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010966 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010967
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010968 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010969 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10970
10971 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10972 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10973
10974 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10975 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010977
10978 Example :
10979 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10980 backend private_monitoring
10981 stats enable
10982 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10983 stats uri /admin?stats
10984 stats refresh 5s
10985
10986 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10987 global section.
10988
10989
10990stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010991 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10993 yes | yes | yes | yes
10994 Arguments : none
10995
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010996 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010997 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10998 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10999 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11000 - IP (socket, server)
11001 - cookie (backend, server)
11002
11003 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11004 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011005 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011006
11007 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11008
11009
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011010stats show-modules
11011 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11013 yes | yes | yes | yes
11014 Arguments : none
11015
11016 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11017 values as a tooltip.
11018
11019 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11020 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11021 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11022
11023 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11024
11025
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011026stats show-node [ <name> ]
11027 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011030 Arguments:
11031 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11032 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11033
11034 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11035 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011036 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011037
11038 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11039 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11040 unobvious parameters.
11041
11042 Example:
11043 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11044 backend private_monitoring
11045 stats enable
11046 stats show-node Europe-1
11047 stats uri /admin?stats
11048 stats refresh 5s
11049
11050 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11051 section.
11052
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011053
11054stats uri <prefix>
11055 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011057 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011058 Arguments :
11059 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11060 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11061 query string.
11062
11063 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11064 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11065 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11066 possible to reach it in the application.
11067
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011068 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011069 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011070 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11071 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11072 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11073 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11074
11075 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11076 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11077 an address or a port to statistics only.
11078
11079 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11080 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11081 unobvious parameters.
11082
11083 Example :
11084 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11085 backend public_www
11086 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11087 stats enable
11088 stats hide-version
11089 stats scope .
11090 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011091 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011092 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11093 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11094
11095 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11096 backend private_monitoring
11097 stats enable
11098 stats uri /admin?stats
11099 stats refresh 5s
11100
11101 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11102
11103
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011104stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11105 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011107 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011108
11109 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011110 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011111 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011112 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011113 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11114
11115 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11116 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11117 the "stick-table" statement.
11118
11119 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11120 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11121 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11122 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11123 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11124
11125 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11126 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11127 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11128 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11129 transformation rules.
11130
11131 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11132 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11133 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11134 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11135 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11136 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11137 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11138
11139 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11140 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11141 ACL based conditions.
11142
11143 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11144 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11145 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11146 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11147
11148 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11149 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11150 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11151 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11152
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011153 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11154 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011155 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011156
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011157 Example :
11158 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11159 # last 30 minutes
11160 backend pop
11161 mode tcp
11162 balance roundrobin
11163 stick store-request src
11164 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11165 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11166 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11167
11168 backend smtp
11169 mode tcp
11170 balance roundrobin
11171 stick match src table pop
11172 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11173 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11174
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011175 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011176 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011177
11178
11179stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11180 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11182 no | no | yes | yes
11183
11184 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11185 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11186 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11187 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11188
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011189 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11190 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011191 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011192
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011193 Examples :
11194 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011195 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011196
11197 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11198 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11199 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11200
11201
11202 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11203 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11204 backend http
11205 mode http
11206 balance roundrobin
11207 stick on src table https
11208 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11209 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11210 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11211
11212 backend https
11213 mode tcp
11214 balance roundrobin
11215 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11216 stick on src
11217 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11218 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11219
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011220 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011221
11222
11223stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11224 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11226 no | no | yes | yes
11227
11228 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011229 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011230 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011231 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011232 server is selected.
11233
11234 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11235 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11236 the "stick-table" statement.
11237
11238 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11239 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11240 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11241 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11242 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11243 address.
11244
11245 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11246 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11247 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11248 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11249 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11250 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11251 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11252 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11253 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11254 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11255
11256 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11257 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11258 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11259 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11260 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11261 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11262 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11263
11264 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11265 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11266 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11267 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11268
11269 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11270 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11271 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11272 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11273 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11274 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011275 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11276 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11277 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11278 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11279 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11280 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011281
11282 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11283 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11284 the request.
11285
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011286 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11287 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011288 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011289
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011290 Example :
11291 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11292 # last 30 minutes
11293 backend pop
11294 mode tcp
11295 balance roundrobin
11296 stick store-request src
11297 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11298 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11299 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11300
11301 backend smtp
11302 mode tcp
11303 balance roundrobin
11304 stick match src table pop
11305 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11306 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11307
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011308 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011309 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011310
11311
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011312stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011313 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011314 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011315 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011317 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011318
11319 Arguments :
11320 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11321 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11322 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11323 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11324
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011325 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11326 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11327 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11328 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11329
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011330 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11331 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11332 instance.
11333
11334 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11335 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11336 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11337 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11338 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11339 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011340 to 32 characters.
11341
11342 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11343 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11344 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011345 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011346 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11347 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011348
11349 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011350 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11351 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011352 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11353 increase.
11354
11355 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011356 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11357 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11358 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011359
11360 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011361 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011362 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11363 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011364 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011365 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11366 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11367 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11368 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11369 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11370 parameter (see below).
11371
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011372 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11373 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11374 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11375 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11376 soft restart.
11377
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011378 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11379 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011380
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011381 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011382 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11383 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011384 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11385 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011386 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011387 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011388 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11389 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011390 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11391 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011392
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011393 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11394 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11395 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11396 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11397 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11398 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11399 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11400 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11401 token.
11402
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011403 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11404 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11405 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11406 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011407 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11408 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11409 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11410 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11411 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11412 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11413 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11414 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11415 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11416 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11417 types and their arguments.
11418
11419 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11420 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11421 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11422 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11423
11424 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11425 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11426 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011427 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011428
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011429 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11430 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11431 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011432 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011433 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011434 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011435
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011436 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11437 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11438 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11439 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11440
11441 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11442 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11443 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11444 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11445 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11446 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11447
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011448 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11449 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11450 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11451 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11452
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011453 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11454 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11455 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11456 they were received.
11457
11458 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11459 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11460 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11461 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11462 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11463
11464 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11465 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11466 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11467 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11468 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11469
11470 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11471 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11472 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11473
11474 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11477 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11478 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11479
11480 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11481 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11482 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11483 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11484 the client side.
11485
11486 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11487 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11488 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11489 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11490 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11491 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11492 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11493
11494 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11495 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11496 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11497 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11498 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11499 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011501
11502 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11503 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11504 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11505 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11506 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11507 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11508
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011509 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11510 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11511 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11512 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11513 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11514
11515 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11516 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11517 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11518 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11519 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11520 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11521
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011522 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011523 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011524 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11525 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11526
11527 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11528 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11529 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11530 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11531 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11532 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11533 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11534 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11535 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11536 recommended for better fairness.
11537
11538 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011539 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011540 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11541 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11542
11543 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11544 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11545 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11546 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11547 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11548 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11549 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11550 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11551 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11552 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011553
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011554 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11555 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011556 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11557 reference it.
11558
11559 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11560 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011561 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11562 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11563 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011564
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011565 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11566 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11567 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11568 something that can be ignored.
11569
11570 Example:
11571 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11572 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11573 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11574 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11575
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011576 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011577 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011578
11579
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011580stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011581 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11583 no | no | yes | yes
11584
11585 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011586 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011587 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011588 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011589 server is selected.
11590
11591 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11592 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11593 the "stick-table" statement.
11594
11595 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11596 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11597 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11598 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11599
11600 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11601 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11602 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11603 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11604 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11605 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011606 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011607 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11608 rules.
11609
11610 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11611 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11612 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11613 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11614 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11615 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11616 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11617
11618 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11619 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11620 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11621 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11622
11623 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11624 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11625 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11626 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11627 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11628 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011629 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11630 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11631 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11632 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11633 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11634 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11635 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11636 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11637 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011638
11639 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11640
11641 Example :
11642 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11643 backend https
11644 mode tcp
11645 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011646 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011647 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011648
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011649 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11650 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011651
11652 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11653 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11654 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11655
11656 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11657 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011658
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011659 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11660 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11661 # at offset 44.
11662
11663 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011664 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011665
11666 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011667 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011668
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011669 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11670 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11671
11672 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11673 extraction.
11674
11675
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011676tcp-check comment <string>
11677 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11678 it fails.
11679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11680 yes | no | yes | yes
11681
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011682 Arguments :
11683 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11684 rule fails.
11685
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011686 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11687 user-friendly error reporting.
11688
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011689 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11690 "tcp-check expect".
11691
11692
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011693tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11694 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011695 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011696 Opens a new connection
11697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011698 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011699
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011700 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011701 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11702
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011703 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011704 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011705
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011706 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011707 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11708 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011709 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011710
11711 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011712
11713 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11714
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011715 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11716
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011717 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11718
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011719 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11720
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011721 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11722 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11723 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11724 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11725
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011726 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11727 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11728 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11729 haproxy -vv.
11730
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011731 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011732
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011733 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11734 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11735 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11736
11737 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11738 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11739 of the sequence.
11740
11741 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11742 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11743 do.
11744
11745 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11746 unset-var or comment rules.
11747
11748 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011749 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11750 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11751 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11752 option tcp-check
11753 tcp-check connect
11754 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11755 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11756 tcp-check send \r\n
11757 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11758 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11759 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11760 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11761 tcp-check send \r\n
11762 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11763 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11764
11765 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11766 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011767 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011768 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11769 tcp-check connect port 143
11770 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11771 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11772
11773 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11774
11775
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011776tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011777 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011778 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011779 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011780 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011781 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011782 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011783
11784 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011785 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11786
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011787 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11788 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11789 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11790 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11791 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11792 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11793 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11794 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11795 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11796 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11797
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011798 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011799 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11800 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011801 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11802 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11803 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11804
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011805 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11806 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11807 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011808 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11809 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011810 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11811 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011812 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11813 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011814 By default "L7OK" is used.
11815
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011816 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11817 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011818 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11819 supported :
11820 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11821 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011822 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11823 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11824 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11825 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11826 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011827
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011828 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011829 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011830 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11831 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11832 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11833 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011834 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11835
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011836 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11837 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11838 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11839 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11840
11841 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11842 informational message reported in logs if an error
11843 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11844 log-format string.
11845
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011846 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11847 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11848 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11849 followed by some converters.
11850
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011851 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11852 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11853 with the usual backslash ('\').
11854 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011855 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011856 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11857 used upper or lower case.
11858
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011859 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11860
11861 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11862 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11863 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11864 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11865 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11866 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11867 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11868 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11869
11870 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11871 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11872 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11873 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11874 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11875 expression.
11876
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011877 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11878 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11879 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11880 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11881 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11882 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11883
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011884 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11885 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11886 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11887 this exact hexadecimal string.
11888 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11889
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011890 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11891 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11892 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11893 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11894 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11895 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11896 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11897 size.
11898
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011899 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11900 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11901 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11902 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11903 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11904 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11905 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11906 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11907 in a binary string before matching the response's
11908 buffer.
11909
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011910 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011911 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011912 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11913 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11914 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11915 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11916 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11917 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11918 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11919 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11920 the null character.
11921
11922 Examples :
11923 # perform a POP check
11924 option tcp-check
11925 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11926
11927 # perform an IMAP check
11928 option tcp-check
11929 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11930
11931 # look for the redis master server
11932 option tcp-check
11933 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011934 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011935 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11936 tcp-check expect string role:master
11937 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11938 tcp-check expect string +OK
11939
11940
11941 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011942 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011943
11944
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011945tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11946tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11947 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11948 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011950 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011951
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011952 Arguments :
11953 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11954
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011955 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11956 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011957
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011958 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11959 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011960
11961 Examples :
11962 # look for the redis master server
11963 option tcp-check
11964 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11965 tcp-check expect string role:master
11966
11967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011968 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
11970
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011971tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11972tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11973 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11974 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011975 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011976 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011977
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011978 Arguments :
11979 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011980
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011981 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11982 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011983
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011984 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11985 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11986 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011987
11988 Examples :
11989 # redis check in binary
11990 option tcp-check
11991 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11992 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11993
11994
11995 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011996 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011997
11998
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011999tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012000 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012001 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012002 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012003
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012004 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12006 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12009 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12011 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12012 and '-'.
12013
12014 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12015
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012016 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012017 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
12018
12019
12020tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012021 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012022 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012023 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012024
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012025 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012026 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12027 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12028 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12029 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12030 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12031 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12032 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12033 and '-'.
12034
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012035 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012036 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12037
12038
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012039tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12040 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12042 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012043 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012044 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12045 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012047 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012048
12049 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12050 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012051 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12052 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12053 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12054 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12055 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12056 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012057
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012058 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12059 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12060 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12061 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012062
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012063 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012064 - accept :
12065 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12066 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12067 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012069 - reject :
12070 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12071 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12072 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12073 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12074 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12075 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12076 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12077 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12078 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12079 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12080 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012081 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012082
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012083 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12084 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12085 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12086 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12087 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12088 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12089 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12090 hosts.
12091
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012092 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12093 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12094 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12095 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12096 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12097 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12098 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12099 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12100
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012101 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12102 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12103 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12104 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12105 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12106 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12107 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12108 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12109 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012110 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12111 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012112
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012113 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012114 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012115 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12116 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12117 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012118 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012119 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012120 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12121 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12122 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12123 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12124 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12125 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12126 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012127
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012129 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012130 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012131 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012132 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12133 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12134 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012135
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012136 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12137 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12138 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12139 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012140
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012141 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12142 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12143 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12144 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12145 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012146 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12147 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12148 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12149 layer7 information is extracted.
12150
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012151 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12152 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12153 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12154 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12155 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012156
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012157 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12158 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12159 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12160 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12161
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012162 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12163 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12164 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12165 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12166
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012167 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12168 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12169 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12170 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12171 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012172
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012173 - set-src <expr> :
12174 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12175 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12176 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012177 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012179 Arguments:
12180 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12181 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012182
12183 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012184 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12185
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012186 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12187 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012188
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012189 - set-src-port <expr> :
12190 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12191 expression.
12192
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012193 Arguments:
12194 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12195 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012196
12197 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012198 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12199
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012200 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12201 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12202 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012203
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012204 - set-dst <expr> :
12205 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12206 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12207 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12208 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12209 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12210
12211 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12212 followed by some converters.
12213
12214 Example:
12215
12216 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12217 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12218
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012219 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12220 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12221
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012222 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12223 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12224 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12225 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12226
12227
12228 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12229 followed by some converters.
12230
12231 Example:
12232
12233 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12234
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012235 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12236 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12237 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12238
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012239 - "silent-drop" :
12240 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012241 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012242 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12243 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12244 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12245 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12246 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012247 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12248 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012249 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12250 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012251 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012252 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12253 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12254 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12255 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12256
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012257 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12258 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12259 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012260
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012261 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12262 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12263 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012264
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012265 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012266 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012267 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012268
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012269 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12270 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12271 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012273 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012274 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12275 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012276
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012277 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12278
12279 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12280
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012281 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12282
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012283 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012284
12285
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012286tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12287 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012289 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012290 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012291 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12292 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012295
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012296 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012297 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12298 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012299 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12300 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012301
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012302 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12303 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12304 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12305 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012306 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012307 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012308 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12309 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12310 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12311 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012312 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012313 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012314
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012315 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12316 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12317 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12318 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012319
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012320 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012321 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012322 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012323 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12324 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012325 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012326 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012327 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012328 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012329 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012330 - set-dst <expr>
12331 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012332 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012333 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012334 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012335 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012336 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012337 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012338
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012339 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12340 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012341 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12342 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012343
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012344 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12345 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12346 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12347 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12348 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12349 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012351 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012352 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12353 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012354
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012355 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12356 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12357 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12358 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12359 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12360 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012362 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012363 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12364 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12365 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12366 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12367 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12368 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12369 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12370 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12371 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12372 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012373
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012374 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012375 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12376 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12377 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012378
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012379 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12380 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12381
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012382 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012383 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12384 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012385
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012386 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12387 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012388 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012389 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12390 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012391 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012392 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012393 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012394 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12395 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012396 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012397 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12398 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012399
12400 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12401 followed by some converters.
12402
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012403 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012404 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12405 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12406 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12407 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12408 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12409 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012410 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012411 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12412 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12413
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012414 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12415
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012416 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12417 <var-name>.
12418
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012419 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12420 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12421 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12422 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12423 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12424
12425 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12426 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12427 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12428 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12429 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12430 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12431 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12432 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12433 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12434 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12435 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12436
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012437 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12438 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12439 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12440 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12441 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12442
12443 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12444
12445 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12446
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012447 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12448 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12449 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12450 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12451 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12452 evaluated.
12453
12454 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONdf332122022-10-05 18:09:33 +020012455 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012456
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012457 Example:
12458
12459 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012460 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012461
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012462 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012463 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012464 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012465 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12466 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012467 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012468 tcp-request content reject
12469
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012470 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12471 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12472 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12473 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12474 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12475 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12476 ...
12477 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012479 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012480 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12481 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012482 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012483 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012484
12485 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12486 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012487 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012488 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012489 tcp-request content reject
12490
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012491 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012492 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012493 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012494 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012495 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12496 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012497
12498 Example:
12499 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12500 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012501 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012502
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012503 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012504 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012505
12506 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012507 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012508 # protecting all our sites
12509 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012510 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12511 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012512 ...
12513 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12514
12515 backend http_dynamic
12516 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012517 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012518 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012519 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012520 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012521 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012522 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012524 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012525
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012526 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12527 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012528
12529
12530tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12531 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12532 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012533 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012534 Arguments :
12535 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12536 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12537 as explained at the top of this document.
12538
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012539 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012540 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12541 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12542 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12543 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12544
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012545 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12546 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12547 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12548 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12549
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012550 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012551 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012552 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012553 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012554 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012555 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12556 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12557 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012558
12559 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12560 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12561 it pass through unaffected.
12562
12563 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12564 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12565 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012566 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012567 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12568 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012569 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12570 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12571 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012572
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012573 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012574 "timeout client".
12575
12576
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012577tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12578 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12580 no | no | yes | yes
12581 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012582 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12583 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012584
12585 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12586
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012587 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012588 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12589 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012590 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12591 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012592
12593 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12594
12595 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12596 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12597 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12598 inserted.
12599
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012600 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012601 - accept :
12602 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12603 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12604 the rules evaluation.
12605
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012606 - close :
12607 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12608 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12609 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12610 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12611 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12612 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012613 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012614 protocols.
12615
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012616 - reject :
12617 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12618 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012619 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012620
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012621 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012622 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012623
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012624 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12625 Unsets a variable.
12626
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012627 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12628 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12629 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12630 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12631
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012632 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12633 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12634 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12635 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12636
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012637 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12638 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12639 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12640 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12641 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012642
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012643 - "silent-drop" :
12644 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012645 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012646 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12647 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12648 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12649 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12650 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012651 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12652 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012653 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12654 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012655 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012656 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12657 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12658 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12659 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12660
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012661 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12662 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12663
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012664 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12665 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12666 for changing the default action to a reject.
12667
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012668 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12669 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12670 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12671 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012672 period.
12673
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012674 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12675 declared inline.
12676
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012677 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12678 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012679 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012680 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12681 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012682 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012683 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012684 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012685 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12686 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012687 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012688 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12689 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012690
12691 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12692 followed by some converters.
12693
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012694 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12695 <var-name>.
12696
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012697 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12698 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12699 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12700 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12701 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12702
12703 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12704
12705 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12706
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012707 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12708
12709 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12710
12711
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012712tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12713 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12714 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12715 no | yes | yes | no
12716 Arguments :
12717 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12718 below.
12719
12720 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12721
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012722 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012723 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12724 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12725 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12726 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12727 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12728 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12729 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012731 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12732 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12733 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12734 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12735 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12736 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12737 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12738 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12739 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12740 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12741 instead.
12742
12743 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12744 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12745 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12746 rules which may be inserted.
12747
12748 Several types of actions are supported :
12749 - accept : the request is accepted
12750 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12751 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12752 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012753 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012754 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012755 - set-dst <expr>
12756 - set-dst-port <expr>
12757 - set-src <expr>
12758 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012759 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012760 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012761 - silent-drop
12762
12763 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12764 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12765 sections for a complete description.
12766
12767 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12768 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12769 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12770
12771 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12772 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12773 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12774 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12775 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12776
12777 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12778 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12779
12780 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12781 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12782 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12783
12784 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12785 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12786 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12787
12788 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12789 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12790 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12791
12792 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12793 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12794 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12795
12796 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12797
12798 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12799
12800
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012801tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12802 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12804 no | no | yes | yes
12805 Arguments :
12806 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12807 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12808 as explained at the top of this document.
12809
12810 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12811
12812
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012813timeout check <timeout>
12814 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12815 established.
12816
12817 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12818 yes | no | yes | yes
12819 Arguments:
12820 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12821 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12822 as explained at the top of this document.
12823
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012824 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012825 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012826 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012827 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012828 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12829 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12830 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012831
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012832 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012833 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12834
12835 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12836 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012837 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012838
12839 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12840 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12841 forget about it.
12842
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012843 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12844 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012845
12846
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012847timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012848 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12850 yes | yes | yes | no
12851 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012852 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012853 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12854 as explained at the top of this document.
12855
12856 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12857 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12858 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012859 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12860 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12861 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12862 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012863 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12864 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12865 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012866 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012867 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012868 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12869 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012870 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12871 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012872
12873 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12874 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12875 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12876 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012877 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012878 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12879
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012880 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012883timeout client-fin <timeout>
12884 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12885 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12886 yes | yes | yes | no
12887 Arguments :
12888 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12889 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12890 as explained at the top of this document.
12891
12892 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12893 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12894 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12895 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12896 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12897 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12898 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012899 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12900 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12901 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012902
12903 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12904 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12905 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12906
12907 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12908
12909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012910timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012911 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12913 yes | no | yes | yes
12914 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012915 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012916 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12917 as explained at the top of this document.
12918
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012919 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012920 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012921 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012922 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012923 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12924 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012925
12926 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12927 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12928 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12929 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012930 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012931 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12932
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012933 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012935
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012936timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12937 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12939 yes | yes | yes | yes
12940 Arguments :
12941 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12942 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12943 as explained at the top of this document.
12944
12945 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12946 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12947 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12948 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12949 once the request has started to present itself.
12950
12951 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12952 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12953 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12954 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12955 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12956
12957 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12958 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12959 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12960 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12961
12962 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12963 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012964 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012965 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12966 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012967 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012968
12969 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12970 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12971 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12972 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12973
12974 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12975
12976
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012977timeout http-request <timeout>
12978 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012980 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012981 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012982 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012983 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12984 as explained at the top of this document.
12985
12986 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12987 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12988 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12989 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12990 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12991 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12992 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012993 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12994 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12995 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12996 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012997 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012998 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12999 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013000
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013001 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13002 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13003 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13004 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13005 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013006 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013007
13008 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13009 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013010 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013011 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13012 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13013
13014 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013015 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13016 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13017 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013018
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013019 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013020 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013021
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013022
13023timeout queue <timeout>
13024 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13026 yes | no | yes | yes
13027 Arguments :
13028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13030 as explained at the top of this document.
13031
13032 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13033 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13034 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13035 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13036 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13037
13038 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13039 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13040 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13041 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13042
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013043 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013044
13045
13046timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013047 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13049 yes | no | yes | yes
13050 Arguments :
13051 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13052 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13053 as explained at the top of this document.
13054
13055 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13056 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13057 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13058 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13059 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13060 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13061 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13062
13063 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13064 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13065 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13066 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13067 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013068 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013069 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013070 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13071 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013072 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13073 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013074
13075 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13076 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13077 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13078 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013079 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013080 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13081
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013082 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013083
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013084
13085timeout server-fin <timeout>
13086 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13088 yes | no | yes | yes
13089 Arguments :
13090 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13091 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13092 as explained at the top of this document.
13093
13094 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13095 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13096 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13097 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13098 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13099 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13100 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13101 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13102 situations, it should not be needed.
13103
13104 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13105 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13106 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13107
13108 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13109
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013110
13111timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013112 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13114 yes | yes | yes | yes
13115 Arguments :
13116 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13117 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13118 as explained at the top of this document.
13119
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013120 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13121 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13122 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013123
13124 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13125 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13126 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13127 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013128 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013129
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013130 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131
13132
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013133timeout tunnel <timeout>
13134 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13136 yes | no | yes | yes
13137 Arguments :
13138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13140 as explained at the top of this document.
13141
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013142 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013143 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13144 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13145 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013146 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13147 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013148 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13149 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13150 specified.
13151
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013152 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13153 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13154 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13155 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13156 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13157 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13158 state.
13159
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013160 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13161 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13162 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13163 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013164 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013165
13166 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13167 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13168 forget about it.
13169
13170 Example :
13171 defaults http
13172 option http-server-close
13173 timeout connect 5s
13174 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013175 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013176 timeout server 30s
13177 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13178
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013179 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013180
13181
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013182transparent (deprecated)
13183 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013185 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013186 Arguments : none
13187
13188 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13189 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13190 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13191 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13192 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13193 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13194 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13195 appropriate server.
13196
13197 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13198
13199 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13200 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013202 See also: "option transparent"
13203
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013204unique-id-format <string>
13205 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13206 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13207 yes | yes | yes | no
13208 Arguments :
13209 <string> is a log-format string.
13210
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013211 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13212 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13213 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13214 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013215
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013216 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013217 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013218 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13219 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13220 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13221 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13222 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13223 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013224
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013225 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13226 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013227
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013228 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013229
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013230 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013231
13232 will generate:
13233
13234 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13235
13236 See also: "unique-id-header"
13237
13238unique-id-header <name>
13239 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13241 yes | yes | yes | no
13242 Arguments :
13243 <name> is the name of the header.
13244
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013245 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13246 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013247
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013248 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013249
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013250 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013251 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13252
13253 will generate:
13254
13255 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13256
13257 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013258
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013259use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013260 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13262 no | yes | yes | no
13263 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013264 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13265 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013266
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013267 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13268 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013269
13270 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13271 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13272 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013273 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013274 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013275 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13276 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013277
13278 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13279 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13280 assign the backend.
13281
13282 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13283 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13284 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13285 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13286 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13287 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13288
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013289 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013290 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013291 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13292 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13293 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13294
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013295 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13296 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13297 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13298 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13299 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13300 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13301 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13302 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13303 cannot be forced from the request.
13304
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013305 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013306 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13307 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13308
13309 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13310 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013311
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013312use-fcgi-app <name>
13313 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13315 no | no | yes | yes
13316 Arguments :
13317 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13318
13319 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013320
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013321use-server <server> if <condition>
13322use-server <server> unless <condition>
13323 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13325 no | no | yes | yes
13326 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013327 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13328 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013329
13330 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13331
13332 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13333 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13334 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13335
13336 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13337 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13338 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13339 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13340 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13341 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13342 matches will assign the server.
13343
13344 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13345 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13346 with the next rules until one matches.
13347
13348 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13349 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13350 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13351 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13352
13353 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13354 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13355 stripped.
13356
13357 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13358 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013359 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013360 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013361 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013362
13363 Example :
13364 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013365 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013366 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013367 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013368 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013369 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013370 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013371 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13372 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13373
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013374 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13375 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13376 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13377 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013378 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013379 and we fall back to load balancing.
13380
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013381 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013382
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013383
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133845. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013385--------------------------
13386
13387The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13388depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13389settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13390written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13391described in this section.
13392
13393
133945.1. Bind options
13395-----------------
13396
13397The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13398as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13399no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13400parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13401while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13402provided immediately after the setting name.
13403
13404The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13405
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013406accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13407 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13408 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13409 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13410 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13411 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13412 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13413 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13414 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13415 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013416 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13417 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13418 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013419
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013420accept-proxy
13421 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013422 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13423 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013424 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13425 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13426 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13427 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013428 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13430 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013431 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13432 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013433
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013434allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013435 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013436 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013437 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013438 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13439 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013440
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013441alpn <protocols>
13442 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13443 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13444 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013445 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013446 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013447 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13448 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13449 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13450 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13451 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13452 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13453 preference, like below :
13454
13455 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013456
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013457backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013458 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013459 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13460
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013461curves <curves>
13462 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13463 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13464 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13465 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13466 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13467 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13468
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013469ecdhe <named curve>
13470 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013471 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13472 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013473
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013474ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013475 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13476 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13477 client's certificate.
13478
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013479ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13480 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13481 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13482 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13483 error is ignored.
13484
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013485ca-sign-file <cafile>
13486 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13487 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13488 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13489 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13490 'generate-certificates' for details.
13491
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013492ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013493 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13494 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13495 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13496 'generate-certificates' for details.
13497
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013498ca-verify-file <cafile>
13499 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13500 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13501 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13502 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13503 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13504
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013505ciphers <ciphers>
13506 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13507 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013508 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013509 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013510 information and recommendations see e.g.
13511 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13512 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13513 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13514
13515ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13517 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13518 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13519 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013520 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13521 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013522
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013523crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013524 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13525 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013526 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13527 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013528
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013529crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013530 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13531 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13532 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13533 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13534 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013535 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13536 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013537
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013538 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13539 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13540
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013541 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13542 are loaded.
13543
13544 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013545 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13546 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13547 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13548 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13549 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13550 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13551 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013552 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013553
13554 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13555 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13556 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13557 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013558 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13559 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013560
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013561 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013562
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013563 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013564 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013565 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13566 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013567 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13568 clients).
13569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013570 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013571 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13572 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13573 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13574 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13575 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13576 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13577 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13578 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13579 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13580 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13581 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13582 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13583
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013584 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013585 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13586 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13587 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13588 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13589
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013590 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13591 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13592 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13593 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013594
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013595 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13596 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13597 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013598
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013599crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013601 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013602 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013603 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013604
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013605crt-list <file>
13606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013607 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13608 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013609
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013610 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13611
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013612 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13613 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13614 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13615 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13616 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013617
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013618 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013619 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13620 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13621 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13622 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13623 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013624 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13625 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13626 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013627
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013628 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13629 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13630 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013631
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013632 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13633
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013634 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013635 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013636 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13637 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13638 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13639 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13640 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13641 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013642
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013643 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013644 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013645 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013646 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013647 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013648 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013649
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013650defer-accept
13651 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13652 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13653 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013655 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13656 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13657 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13658 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13659 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13660 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13661 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13662
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013663expose-fd listeners
13664 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13665 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013666 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13667 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013668 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013669
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013670force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013671 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013672 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013673 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013674 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013675
13676force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013677 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013678 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013679 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013680
13681force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013682 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013683 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013684 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013685
13686force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013687 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013688 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013689 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013690
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013691force-tlsv13
13692 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13693 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013694 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013695
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013696generate-certificates
13697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13698 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13699 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13700 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13701 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13702 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13703 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13704 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13705 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13706 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13707 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13708
13709 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13710 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013711 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013712 certificate is used many times.
13713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013714gid <gid>
13715 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13716 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13717 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13718 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13719 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13720
13721group <group>
13722 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13723 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13724 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13725 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13726 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13727
13728id <id>
13729 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13730 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13731 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13732 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13733
13734interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013735 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13736 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13737 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13738 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13739 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13740 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013741 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13742 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13743 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13744 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13745 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13746 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013747
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013748level <level>
13749 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13750 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13751 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013752 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013753 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13754 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13755 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013756 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013757 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013758 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013759 all counters).
13760
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013761severity-output <format>
13762 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13763 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13764 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13765 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13766 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13767 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13768 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13769 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13770 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13771 rfc5424 convention.
13772
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013773maxconn <maxconn>
13774 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13775 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13776 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13777 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13778 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13779 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13780 eat all memory.
13781
13782mode <mode>
13783 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13784 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13785 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13786 UNIX sockets.
13787
13788mss <maxseg>
13789 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13790 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13791 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13792 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13793 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13794 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13795 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13796 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13797 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13798 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13799 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13800
13801name <name>
13802 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13803 page.
13804
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013805namespace <name>
13806 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13807 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13808 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13809 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13810
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013811nice <nice>
13812 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13813 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13814 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13815 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13816 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13817 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13818 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13819 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13820 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13821 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13822 one for an RDP socket.
13823
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013824no-ca-names
13825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13826 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013827 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013828
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013829no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013831 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013832 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013833 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013834 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13835 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013836
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013837no-tls-tickets
13838 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13839 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13840 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013841 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13842 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013843 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13844 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13845 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013847no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013849 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013850 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013851 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013852 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13853 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013854
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013855no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013856 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013857 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013858 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013859 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013860 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13861 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013863no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013865 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013866 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013867 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013868 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13869 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013870
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013871no-tlsv13
13872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13873 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013876 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13877 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013878
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013879npn <protocols>
13880 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13881 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13882 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013883 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013884 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013885 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13886 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13887 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13888 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13889 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013890
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013891prefer-client-ciphers
13892 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13893 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13894 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013895 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13896 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13897 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013898
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013899process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013900 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013901 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013902 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013903 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13904 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13905 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13906 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013907 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013908 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13909 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13910 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13911 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13912 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013913
13914 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13915
13916 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13917 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13918 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13919 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13920 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13921 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13922 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13923 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013924
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013925proto <name>
13926 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13927 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13928 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013929 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13930 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13931
13932 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13933 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13934 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13935 also reported (flag=HTX).
13936
13937 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13938 a bind line :
13939
13940 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13941 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13942 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13943
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013944 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013945 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013946 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013947 h2" on the bind line.
13948
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013949ssl
13950 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013951 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013952 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13953 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013954 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13955 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013956
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013957ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13958 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013959 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13960 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13961 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013962 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13963
13964ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013965 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13966 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13967 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13968 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013969
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013970strict-sni
13971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13972 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13973 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13974 See the "crt" option for more information.
13975
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013976tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013977 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013978 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013979 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013980 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013981 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13982 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13983 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13984 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13985 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13986 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13987 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13988
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013989tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013990 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013991 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13992 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13993 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13994 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13995 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13996 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13997 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013998 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13999 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14000 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014001
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014002tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14003 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014004 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14005 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14006 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14007 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14008 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14009 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14010 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14011 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14012 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14013 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014014 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14015 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14016
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014017transparent
14018 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14019 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14020 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14021 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14022 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14023 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14024 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14025 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14026 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14027 so check for support with your vendor.
14028
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014029v4v6
14030 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14031 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14032 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14033 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014034 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014035
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014036v6only
14037 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14038 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14039 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014040 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14041 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014042
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014043uid <uid>
14044 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14045 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14046 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14047 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14048 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14049
14050user <user>
14051 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14052 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14053 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14054 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14055 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14056
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014057verify [none|optional|required]
14058 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14059 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14060 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14061 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14062 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014063 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14064 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14065 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14066 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140685.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014069------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014070
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014071The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14072which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14073arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14074settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14075after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14076Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14077address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014079 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014080 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014081
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014082Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14083keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014085The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014086
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014087addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014088 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014089 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14090 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14091 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14092 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14093 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014094
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014095agent-check
14096 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014097 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014098 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14099 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14100 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014101
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014102 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014103 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014104 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014105 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14106 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014107
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014108 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14109 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14110 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14111 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14112 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014113
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014114 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014115 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014116
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014117 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14118 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14119 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014120
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014121 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14122 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14123 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014124
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014125 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014126 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14127 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14128 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14129 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014130 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014131 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014132
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014133 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14134 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014135
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014136 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14137 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14138 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14139 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14140 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14141 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14142 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14143 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14144 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014145
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014146 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14147 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014148 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14149 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14150 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014151 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014152
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014153 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014154 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014155
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014156agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014157 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014158 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14159 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14160 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14161 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14162
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014163agent-inter <delay>
14164 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14165 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14166
14167 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14168 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14169 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14170 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14171 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14172 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14173 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14174 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14175 of backends use the same servers.
14176
14177 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14178
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014179agent-addr <addr>
14180 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14181
14182 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014183 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014184 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14185 hostname, it will be resolved.
14186
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014187agent-port <port>
14188 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14189
14190 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14191
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014192allow-0rtt
14193 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014194 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14195 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014196
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014197alpn <protocols>
14198 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14199 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14200 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014201 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014202 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14203 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14204 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14205 now obsolete NPN extension.
14206 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14207 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14208
14209 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14210
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014211 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014213backup
14214 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14215 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14216 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14217 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014218 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14219 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014220
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014221ca-file <cafile>
14222 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14223 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14224 server's certificate.
14225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014226check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014227 This option enables health checks on a server:
14228 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14229 considered available.
14230 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14231 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14232 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14233 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14234 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14235 set.
14236 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14237 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14238 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14239 exchanges succeed.
14240
14241 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14242 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14243 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14244 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14245 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014246 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014247 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14248
14249 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14250 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14251
14252 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14253 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14254
14255 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14256 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14257 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14258 available.
14259
14260 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14261 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14262 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14263
14264 Example:
14265 # simple tcp check
14266 backend foo
14267 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14268 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14269 backend foo
14270 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14271 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14272 backend foo
14273 option tcp-check
14274 tcp-check connect
14275 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014276
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014277check-send-proxy
14278 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14279 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14280 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14281 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14282 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14283 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14284 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14285
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014286check-alpn <protocols>
14287 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14288 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14289 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14290
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014291check-proto <name>
14292 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14293 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14294 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014295 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14296 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14297
14298 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14299 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14300 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14301 also reported (flag=HTX).
14302
14303 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14304 directive on a server line:
14305
14306 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14307 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14308 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14309 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14310
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014311 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014312 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14313 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14314
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014315check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014316 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014317 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14318 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014319
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014320check-ssl
14321 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14322 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14323 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14324 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014325 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014326 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14327 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014328 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014329 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14330 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014331
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014332check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014333 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014334 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14335 for normal traffic.
14336
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014337ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14339 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14340 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014341 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14342 information and recommendations see e.g.
14343 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14344 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14345 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014346
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014347ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14349 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14350 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14351 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014352 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14353 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14354 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014356cookie <value>
14357 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14358 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14359 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14360 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14361 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14362 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14363 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14364
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014365crl-file <crlfile>
14366 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14367 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14368 to verify server's certificate.
14369
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014370crt <cert>
14371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14372 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14373 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14374 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14375 certificate request.
14376
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014377 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14378 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14379 option is set accordingly).
14380
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014381disabled
14382 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14383 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14384 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14385 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14386 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014387 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014388
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014389enabled
14390 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14391 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14392 default value.
14393 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14394 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014395
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014396error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014397 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14398 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14399 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014401 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014403fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014404 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14405 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14406 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14407
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014408force-sslv3
14409 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14410 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014411 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014412 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014413
14414force-tlsv10
14415 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014416 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014417 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014418
14419force-tlsv11
14420 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014421 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014422 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014423
14424force-tlsv12
14425 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014426 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014427 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014428
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014429force-tlsv13
14430 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14431 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014432 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014433
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014434id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014435 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14436 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14437 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014438
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014439init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14440 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14441 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014442 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014443 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14444 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14445 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14446 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14447 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14448 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14449 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14450 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14451 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014452 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014453 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14454 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14455 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14456 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14457 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14458 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014459 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014460
14461 Example:
14462 defaults
14463 # never fail on address resolution
14464 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014466inter <delay>
14467fastinter <delay>
14468downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014469 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14470 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14471 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14472 between checks depending on the server state :
14473
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014474 Server state | Interval used
14475 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14476 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14477 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14478 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14479 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14480 or yet unchecked. |
14481 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14482 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14483 | "inter" otherwise.
14484 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014486 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14487 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14488 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14489 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014490 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14491 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14492 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14493 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14494 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014495
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014496log-proto <logproto>
14497 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14498 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14499 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14500 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14501
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014502maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014503 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14504 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014505 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14506 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014507 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14508 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14509 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14510 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14511
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014512 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14513 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14514 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14515 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14516 than 50 concurrent requests.
14517
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014518maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014519 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14520 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14521 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14522 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014523 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14524 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14525 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14526 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14527 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14528 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14529 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014530
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014531max-reuse <count>
14532 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14533 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14534 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14535 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14536 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14537 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14538 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14539 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14540
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014541minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014542 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14543 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14544 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14545 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14546 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14547 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014548 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014549 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014550
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014551namespace <name>
14552 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14553 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14554 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14555 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14556
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014557no-agent-check
14558 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14559 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14560 default value.
14561 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14562 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14563
14564no-backup
14565 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14566 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14567 default value.
14568 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14569 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14570
14571no-check
14572 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14573 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14574 default value.
14575 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14576 "default-server" "check" setting.
14577
14578no-check-ssl
14579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14583 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14584
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014585no-send-proxy
14586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14588 default value.
14589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14590 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14591
14592no-send-proxy-v2
14593 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14594 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14595 default value.
14596 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14597 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14598
14599no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14600 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14601 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14602 default value.
14603 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14604 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14605
14606no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14607 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14608 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14609 default value.
14610 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14611 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14612
14613no-ssl
14614 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14615 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14616 default value.
14617 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14618 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14619
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014620 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14621 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14622 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14623
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014624no-ssl-reuse
14625 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14626 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14627 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14628 and for paranoid users.
14629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014630no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014631 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14632 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014633 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014634
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014635 Supported in default-server: No
14636
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014637no-tls-tickets
14638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14639 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14640 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014641 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14642 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014643 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14644 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14645 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014646 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014647
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014648no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014649 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014650 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14651 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014652 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14653 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014654 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014655
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014656 Supported in default-server: No
14657
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014658no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014659 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014660 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14661 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014662 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14663 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014664 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014665
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014666 Supported in default-server: No
14667
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014668no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014669 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014670 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14671 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014672 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14673 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014674 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014675
14676 Supported in default-server: No
14677
14678no-tlsv13
14679 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14680 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14681 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14682 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14683 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014684 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014685
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014686 Supported in default-server: No
14687
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014688no-verifyhost
14689 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14690 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14691 default value.
14692 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14693 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014694
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014695no-tfo
14696 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14697 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14698 default value.
14699 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14700 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14701
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014702non-stick
14703 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14704 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14705 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14706
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014707npn <protocols>
14708 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14709 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14710 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014711 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014712 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14713 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14714 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014716observe <mode>
14717 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14718 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14719 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14720 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14721 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14722 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014723 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014724
14725 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14726
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014727on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014728 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14729 Currently, four modes are available:
14730 - fastinter: force fastinter
14731 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14732 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14733 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14734 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14735
14736 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14737
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014738on-marked-down <action>
14739 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14740 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014741 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14742 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14743 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14744 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14745 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14746 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14747 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14748 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014749
14750 Actions are disabled by default
14751
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014752on-marked-up <action>
14753 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14754 Currently one action is available:
14755 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14756 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14757 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14758 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014759 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14760 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014761 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14762 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14763
14764 Actions are disabled by default
14765
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014766pool-low-conn <max>
14767 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14768 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14769 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14770 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14771 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14772 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14773 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14774 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14775 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14776 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014777 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14778 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14779 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14780 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014781
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014782pool-max-conn <max>
14783 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14784 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14785 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14786 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14787 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14788 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14789
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014790pool-purge-delay <delay>
14791 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014792 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014793 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014795port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014796 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014797 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14798 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14799 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14800 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14801 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014802
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014803proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014804 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14805 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14806 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014807 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14808 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14809
14810 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14811 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14812 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14813 also reported (flag=HTX).
14814
14815 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14816 a server line :
14817
14818 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14819 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14820 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14821 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14822
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014823 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014824 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14825
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014826 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014828redir <prefix>
14829 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14830 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14831 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14832 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14833 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14834 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14835 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14836 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014837 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014838 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014839 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14840 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14841 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14842 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14843
14844 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014846rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014847 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14848 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14849 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14850
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014851resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14852 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14853 server.
14854
14855 Available options:
14856
14857 * allow-dup-ip
14858 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14859 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14860 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14861 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14862 For such case, simply enable this option.
14863 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14864
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014865 * ignore-weight
14866 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14867 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14868 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14869
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014870 * prevent-dup-ip
14871 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14872 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14873 same fqdn.
14874 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14875
14876 Example:
14877 backend b_myapp
14878 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14879 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14880 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14881
14882 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14883 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14884 it
14885 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14886 different address
14887
14888 Default value: not set
14889
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014890resolve-prefer <family>
14891 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14892 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14893 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14894 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14895
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014896 Default value: ipv6
14897
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014898 Example:
14899
14900 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014901
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014902resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014903 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014904 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014905 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014906 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14907 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014908 configured network, another address is selected.
14909
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014910 Example:
14911
14912 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014913
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014914resolvers <id>
14915 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14916 hostname.
14917
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014918 Example:
14919
14920 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014921
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014922 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014923
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014924send-proxy
14925 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14926 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14927 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14928 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014929 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14930 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14931 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14932 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014933 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014934 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14935 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14936 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14937 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14938 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014939 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14940 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014941
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014942send-proxy-v2
14943 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14944 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14945 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14946 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014947 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14948 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14949 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14950 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014951
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014952proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014953 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14954 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14955
14956 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14957 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14958 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14959 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14960 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14961 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14962 connection is supported).
14963 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14964 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14965 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14966 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14967 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14968 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14969 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014970
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014971send-proxy-v2-ssl
14972 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14973 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14974 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14975 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14976 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14977 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14978 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014979 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14980 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014981
14982send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14983 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14984 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14985 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14986 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14987 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14988 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14989 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14990 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014991 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14992 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014994slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014995 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14996 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14997 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14998 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14999 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15000 parameters :
15001
15002 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15003 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15004
15005 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15006 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15007 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15008 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15009
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015010 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015011 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15012 seen as failed.
15013
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015014sni <expression>
15015 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15016 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15017 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010015018 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
15019 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
15020 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
15021 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015022 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015023 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015024 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15025 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015026
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015027source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015028source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015029source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015030 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15031 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15032 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15033 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15034
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015035 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15036 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15037 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15038 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15039 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15040 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15041 server.
15042
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015043 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15044 specifying the source address without port(s).
15045
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015046ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015047 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15048 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15049 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15050 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15051 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15052 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015053 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15054 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015055
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015056ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15057 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15058 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15059 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15060
15061ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15062 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15063 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15064 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15065
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015066ssl-reuse
15067 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15068 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15069 default value.
15070 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15071 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15072
15073stick
15074 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15075 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15076 default value.
15077 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15078 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015079
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015080socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015081 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015082 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15083 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15084
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015085tcp-ut <delay>
15086 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015087 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015088 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015089 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015090 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15091 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15092 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15093 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15094 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15095 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15096 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15097 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15098 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15099
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015100tfo
15101 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15102 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15103 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15104 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015105 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015106 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015108track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015109 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15110 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15111 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15112 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015113 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15114
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015115tls-tickets
15116 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15117 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15118 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015119 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15120 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15121 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015122 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015123 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015124
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015125verify [none|required]
15126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015127 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015128 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15129 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015130 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015131 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15132 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15133 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15134 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15135 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15136 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15137 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15138 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015139
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015140verifyhost <hostname>
15141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015142 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15143 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15144 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15145 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15146 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15147 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15148 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15149 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015151weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015152 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15153 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15154 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015155 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15156 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15157 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15158 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15159 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15160 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015161
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015162ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15163 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15164 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15165 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15166
15167 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15168 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15169 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15170 server ALPN contains it.
15171
15172 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15173 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15174 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15175 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15176
15177 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15178 favor of the ALPN extension.
15179
15180 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15181
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015182
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151835.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15184-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015185
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015186HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15187using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015188configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015189This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15190can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15191workload.
15192This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15193resolution at run time.
15194Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15195carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15196
15197
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151985.3.1. Global overview
15199----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015200
15201As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15202different steps of the process life:
15203
15204 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15205 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15206 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15207
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015208 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15209 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015210
15211A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15212 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15213 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15214 resolution to know this new IP.
15215
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015216When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015217HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015218SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15219from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015220will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015221will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015222
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015223A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015224 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015225 first valid response.
15226
15227 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15228 servers return an error.
15229
15230
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152315.3.2. The resolvers section
15232----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015233
15234This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015235HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15236contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015237
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015238When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15239uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15240is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15241answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15242
15243When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015244used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015245
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015246 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15247 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15248 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015249
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015250 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15251 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015252
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015253 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015254 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15255 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015256
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015257For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15258following scenarios are possible:
15259
15260 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15261 ignored
15262
15263 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15264 applied
15265
15266 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15267 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15268
15269 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15270 retries the query with a new type
15271
15272 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15273 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015274
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015275As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015276a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015277<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015278
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015279
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015280resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015281 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015282
15283A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15284
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015285accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015286 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015287 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015288 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15289 by RFC 6891)
15290
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015291 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15292 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15293 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15294 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15295 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15296 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015297
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015298nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15299 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15300 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15301 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15302 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15303 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15304 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15305 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15306 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15307 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015308 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15309
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015310parse-resolv-conf
15311 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15312 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15313 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15314
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015315hold <status> <period>
15316 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15317 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015318 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015319 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015320 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15321 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15322 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15323
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015324 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015325
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015326resolve_retries <nb>
15327 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15328 giving up.
15329 Default value: 3
15330
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015331 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15332 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15333 type.
15334
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015335timeout <event> <time>
15336 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15337 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15338 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015339 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15340 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015341 Default value: 1s
15342 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015343 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015344 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015345 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15346 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15347
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015348 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015349
15350 resolvers mydns
15351 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15352 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015353 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015354 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015355 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015356 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015357 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015358 hold other 30s
15359 hold refused 30s
15360 hold nx 30s
15361 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015362 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015363 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015364
15365
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153666. Cache
15367---------
15368
15369HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15370(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15371RAM.
15372
15373The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15374this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15375
15376If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15377independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15378when we try to allocate a new one.
15379
15380The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15381
15382It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15383"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15384for more details.
15385
15386When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15387replaced by "<CACHE>".
15388
15389
153906.1. Limitation
15391----------------
15392
15393The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15394
15395- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015396- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15397 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15398 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015399- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15400- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015401- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15402 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15403 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015404- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15405 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015406- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15407 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15408 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015409
15410- If the request is not a GET
15411- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15412- If the request contains an Authorization header
15413
15414
154156.2. Setup
15416-----------
15417
15418To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15419the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15420
15421
154226.2.1. Cache section
15423---------------------
15424
15425cache <name>
15426 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15427 size of cache is mandatory.
15428
15429total-max-size <megabytes>
15430 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15431 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15432
15433max-object-size <bytes>
15434 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15435 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15436 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15437
15438max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015439 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015440 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15441 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15442 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15443 default.
15444
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015445process-vary <on/off>
15446 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015447 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15448 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15449 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015450 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015451
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015452max-secondary-entries <number>
15453 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15454 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15455 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15456
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015457
154586.2.2. Proxy section
15459---------------------
15460
15461http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15462 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15463 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15464 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15465 after this one.
15466
15467http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15468 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15469 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15470 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15471 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15472
15473
15474Example:
15475
15476 backend bck1
15477 mode http
15478
15479 http-request cache-use foobar
15480 http-response cache-store foobar
15481 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15482
15483 cache foobar
15484 total-max-size 4
15485 max-age 240
15486
15487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154887. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15489----------------------------------
15490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015491HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015492client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15493The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15494these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15495but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15496data called patterns.
15497
15498
154997.1. ACL basics
15500---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015501
15502The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15503content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15504from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15505simple :
15506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015507 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015508 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15510 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015512The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15513adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015514
15515In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015517 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015518
15519This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15520Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15521and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015522an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15523conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15524as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15525are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015526
15527ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15528'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15529which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15530
15531There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15532performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015534The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15535specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15536this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015537methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15538ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015539
15540Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15541 - boolean
15542 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15543 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15544 - string
15545 - data block
15546
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015547Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15548converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15549would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15550The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15551which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15552
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015553Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15554keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15555fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15556which are summarized in the table below :
15557
15558 +---------------------+-----------------+
15559 | Sample or converter | Default |
15560 | output type | matching method |
15561 +---------------------+-----------------+
15562 | boolean | bool |
15563 +---------------------+-----------------+
15564 | integer | int |
15565 +---------------------+-----------------+
15566 | ip | ip |
15567 +---------------------+-----------------+
15568 | string | str |
15569 +---------------------+-----------------+
15570 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15571 +---------------------+-----------------+
15572
15573Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15574matching method, see below.
15575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015576The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15577 - boolean
15578 - integer or integer range
15579 - IP address / network
15580 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15581 - regular expression
15582 - hex block
15583
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015584The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15585
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015586 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15587 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015588 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015589 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015590 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015591 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015592 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015594The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15595read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15596if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15597lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15598will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15599beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015600a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015601lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15602exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15603
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015604The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15605parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15606ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15607a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15608check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15609
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015610The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15611socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15612file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15615loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15616
15617 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15618
15619In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15620the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15621case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15622as well.
15623
15624The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15625sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15626do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15627methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15628is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015629obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15631default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15632that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15633string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15634
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015635The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15636By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15637string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15638resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015639server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015640waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015641flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15642function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15645sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15646be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015647
15648 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15649 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15651 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15652 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15653 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015654
15655 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15656 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015658
15659 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015661
15662 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015663 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015664
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015665 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015666 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15667
15668 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15669 binary or string samples.
15670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015671 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15672 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15675 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15676 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15679 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15682 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015684 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15685 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15688 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015689 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15692 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15693 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015694
15695For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15696request, it is possible to do :
15697
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015698 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015699
15700In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15701buffer, one would use the following acl :
15702
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015703 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015704
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015705On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15706possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15707
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015708 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015710All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15711criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15712method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreauedbeab12022-11-25 10:49:41 +010015713to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
15714usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
15715converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
15716method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
15717matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15719the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015722the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15723For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15726 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15727 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15728 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015729
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015730
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015731The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15732types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15733combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15734brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15735default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015737 +-------------------------------------------------+
15738 | Input sample type |
15739 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015740 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015741 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15742 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15743 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015744 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015745 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015746 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015747 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015748 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015749 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015750 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015751 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015752 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015753 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015754 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015756 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015758 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015760 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015761 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015762 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015764 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015765 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15766 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15767 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015768
15769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157707.1.1. Matching booleans
15771------------------------
15772
15773In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15774Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15775When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15776that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15777
15778Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15779return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15780"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15781
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157837.1.2. Matching integers
15784------------------------
15785
15786Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15787enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15788to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15789
15790Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15791matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15792lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015793
15794For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15795unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15796representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15797
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015798As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15799two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15800instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15801ranges and operators.
15802
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015803For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015804operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15805Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15806of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015807
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015808Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015809
15810 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15811 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15812 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15813 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15814 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015816For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015817
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015818 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015819
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015820This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15821
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015822 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158257.1.3. Matching strings
15826-----------------------
15827
15828String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15829different forms :
15830
15831 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015832 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015833
15834 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015835 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836
15837 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15838 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15839
15840 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15841 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15842
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015843 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15845 matches.
15846
15847 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15848 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15849 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015850
15851String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15852exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15853characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15854string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15855to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015856before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015857
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015858Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15859(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15860Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15861
15862Example:
15863 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15864 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15865
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15868---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015869
15870Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15871they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15872possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15873passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15874the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015875the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15876match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015877
15878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158797.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15880-------------------------------------
15881
15882It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15883not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15884a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15885to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15886digits may be used upper or lower case.
15887
15888Example :
15889 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015890 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015891
15892
158937.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15894---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015895
15896IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15897netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15898within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015899host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015900difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15901at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15902does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15903parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015904
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015905The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15906abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15907
15908 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15909 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15910 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15911 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15912 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15913 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15914 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15915 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15916
15917Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15918192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15919
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015920IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15921Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15922trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15923IPv6 patterns.
15924
15925HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15926following situations :
15927 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15928 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15929 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15930 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15931 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15932 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15933 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15934 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15935 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15936 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938
159397.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15940----------------------------------
15941
15942Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15943combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15944
15945 - AND (implicit)
15946 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15947 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015949A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15954indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15957"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15958requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15959is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15960
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015961 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015962 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15963 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15964 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015965
15966To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15967and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15968
15969 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15970 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15971 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15972 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15973
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015974 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015975 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15976 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15977 use_backend www if host_www
15978
15979It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15980expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15981be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15982the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15983
15984 The following rule :
15985
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015986 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015987 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015988
15989 Can also be written that way :
15990
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015991 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015992
15993It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15994to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15995simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15996sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15997good use is the following :
15998
15999 With named ACLs :
16000
16001 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16002 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16003 monitor fail if site_dead
16004
16005 With anonymous ACLs :
16006
16007 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16008
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016009See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16010keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016011
16012
160137.3. Fetching samples
16014---------------------
16015
16016Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16017against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16018sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16019ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16020of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16021available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16022
16023This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16024Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16025compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16026deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16027
16028The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16029matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16030method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16031indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16032
16033As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16034when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16035mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16036the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16037ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16038
16039Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16040multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16041when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016042incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16043are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016044is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16045all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16046
16047Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16048 - name
16049 - name(arg1)
16050 - name(arg1,arg2)
16051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016052
160537.3.1. Converters
16054-----------------
16055
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016056Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16057of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16058is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16059was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016060has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016061unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16062
16063These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16064sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16065the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016066support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016067
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016068A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16069support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16070supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16071(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16072bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016074The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016075
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001607651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16077 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16078 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16079 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16080 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16081 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16082
16083 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016084 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16085 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016086 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16087 frontend http-in
16088 bind *:8081
16089 default_backend servers
16090 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16091 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16092
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016093add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016094 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016095 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016096 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16097 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016098 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016099 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16100 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16101 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16102 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016103 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016104 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016105
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016106aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16107 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16108 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16109 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16110 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16111 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16112 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16113
16114 Example:
16115 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16116 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16117
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016118and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016119 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016120 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016121 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16122 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016123 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016124 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16125 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16126 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16127 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016128 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016129 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016130
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016131b64dec
16132 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16133 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016134 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16135 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016136
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016137base64
16138 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016139 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016140 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16141 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016143bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016144 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016145 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016146 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016147 presence of a flag).
16148
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016149bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16150 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16151 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016152 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016153
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016154concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16155 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16156 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16157 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16158 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16159 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16160 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16161 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16162 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16163 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16164 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016165 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016166 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016167 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16168 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016169
16170 Example:
16171 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16172 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16173 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016174 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016175 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16176
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016177cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016178 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16179 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016180
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016181crc32([<avalanche>])
16182 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16183 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16184 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16185 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16186 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16187 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16188 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16189 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16190 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16191 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016192 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16193
16194crc32c([<avalanche>])
16195 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16196 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16197 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16198 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16199 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16200 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16201 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16202 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016203
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016204cut_crlf
16205 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16206 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16207 updated.
16208
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016209da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016210 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16211 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16212 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16213 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016214 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016215 configuration language.
16216
16217 Example:
16218 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016219 bind *:8881
16220 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016221 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016222
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016223debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16224 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16225 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16226 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16227 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16228 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16229 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16230 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16231 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16232 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16233 printable sample types.
16234
16235 Example:
16236 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016237
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016238digest(<algorithm>)
16239 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16240 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016242 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016243 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16244
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016245div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016246 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16247 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016248 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016249 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16250 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016251 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016252 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16253 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16254 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16255 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016256 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016257 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016258
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016259djb2([<avalanche>])
16260 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16261 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16262 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16263 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16264 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16265 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16266 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016267 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16268 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016269
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016270even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016271 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016272 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16273
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016274field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16275 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16276 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16277 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16278 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16279 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16280 fields.
16281
16282 Example :
16283 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16284 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16285 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16286 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16287 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016288
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016289fix_is_valid
16290 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16291 Information eXchange):
16292
16293 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16294 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016295 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016296 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016297 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016298 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16299 checksum
16300
16301 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16302 the server can be parsed.
16303
16304 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16305 message, false if not.
16306
16307 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16308
16309 Example:
16310 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16311 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16312
16313fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16314 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16315 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16316 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16317 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016318 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016319 added.
16320
16321 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16322 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16323 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16324 fix_is_valid converter.
16325
16326 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16327
16328 Example:
16329 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16330 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16331 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16332 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16333 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16334
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016335hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016337 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016338 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016339 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016340
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016341hex2i
16342 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016343 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016344
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016345htonl
16346 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16347 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16348 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16349 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16350
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016351hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016352 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16353 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16354 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16355 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16356
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016357 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016358 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16359
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016360http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016361 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16362 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016363 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16364 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16365 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16366 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16367 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16368 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16369 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16370 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016372iif(<true>,<false>)
16373 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16374 string otherwise.
16375
16376 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016377 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016378
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016379in_table(<table>)
16380 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16381 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16382 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016383 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016384 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16385
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016386ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016387 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016388 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016389 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16390 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16391 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16392 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16393 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016394
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016395json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016396 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016397 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016398 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016399 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16400 of errors:
16401 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16402 bytes, ...)
16403 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16404 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16405
16406 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16407 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16408 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16409 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16410 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16411 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016412 - "ascii" : never fails;
16413 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16414 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016415 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016416 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016417 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16418 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16419
16420 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016421 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016422
16423 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016424 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016425 capture request header user-agent len 150
16426 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016427
16428 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16429 GET / HTTP/1.0
16430 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16431
16432 Output log:
16433 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16434
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016435json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16436 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16437 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16438 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16439 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16440
16441 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16442 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16443
16444 Example:
16445 # get a integer value from the request body
16446 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16447 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16448
16449 # get a key with '.' in the name
16450 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16451 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16452
16453 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16454 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16455
16456 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16457 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16458
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016459language(<value>[,<default>])
16460 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16461 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16462 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16463 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16464 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16465 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16466 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16467 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16468 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016469 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016470 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16471 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016472
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016473 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016474
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016475 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16476 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016477
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016478 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16479 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16480 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16481 use_backend spanish if es
16482 use_backend french if fr
16483 use_backend english if en
16484 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016485
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016486length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016487 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16488 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16489 type. The result is of type integer.
16490
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016491lower
16492 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16493 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16494 type. The result is of type string.
16495
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016496ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16497 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16498 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16499 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16500 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16501 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16502 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16503
16504 Example :
16505
16506 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016507 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016508 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16509
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016510ltrim(<chars>)
16511 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16512 representation of the input sample.
16513
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016514map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16515map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16516map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16517 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16518 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16519 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16520 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16521 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16522 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16523 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16524 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016526 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16527 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16528 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016529
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016530 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016531 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016532
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016533 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16534 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16535 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16536 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016537 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16538 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016539 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16540 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16541 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16542 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16543 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16544 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16545 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16546 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016547 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16548 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16549 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016550 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16551 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16552 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16553 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16554 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016555
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016556 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16557 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16558 the corresponding match text.
16559
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016560 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16561 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16562 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16563 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16564 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016565
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016566 Example :
16567
16568 # this is a comment and is ignored
16569 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16570 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16571 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16572 | | | `---------- value
16573 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16574 | `---------------------------- key
16575 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16576
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016577mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016578 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16579 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016580 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016581 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016582 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016583 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16584 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16585 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16586 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016587 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016588 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016589
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016590mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016591 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16592 <packettype>.
16593 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16594 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16595 from.
16596 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16597 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16598 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16599
16600 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16601 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16602 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16603 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16604
16605 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16606 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16607 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16608 packets only):
16609 17: Session Expiry Interval
16610 33: Receive Maximum
16611 39: Maximum Packet Size
16612 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16613 25: Request Response Information
16614 23: Request Problem Information
16615 21: Authentication Method
16616 22: Authentication Data
16617 18: Will Delay Interval
16618 1: Payload Format Indicator
16619 2: Message Expiry Interval
16620 3: Content Type
16621 8: Response Topic
16622 9: Correlation Data
16623 Not supported yet:
16624 38: User Property
16625
16626 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16627 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16628 packets only):
16629 17: Session Expiry Interval
16630 33: Receive Maximum
16631 36: Maximum QoS
16632 37: Retain Available
16633 39: Maximum Packet Size
16634 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16635 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16636 31: Reason String
16637 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16638 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16639 42: Shared Subscription Available
16640 19: Server Keep Alive
16641 26: Response Information
16642 28: Server Reference
16643 21: Authentication Method
16644 22: Authentication Data
16645 Not supported yet:
16646 38: User Property
16647
16648 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16649 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16650 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16651 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16652
16653 Example:
16654
16655 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16656 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16657 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16658 if data_in_buffer
16659 # do the same as above
16660 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16661 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16662 if data_in_buffer
16663
16664mqtt_is_valid
16665 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16666
16667 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16668 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16669 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16670 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16671
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016672 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16673
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016674 Example:
16675
16676 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016677 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016678
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016679mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016680 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016681 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16682 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016683 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016684 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016685 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016686 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16687 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16688 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16689 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016690 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016691 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016692
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016693nbsrv
16694 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16695 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16696 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16697 map lookup.
16698
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016699neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016700 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16701 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16702 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16703 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016704
16705not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016706 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016707 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016708 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016709 absence of a flag).
16710
16711odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016712 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016713 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16714
16715or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016716 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016717 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016718 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16719 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16724 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016725 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016726 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016727
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016728protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16729 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16730 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16731 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16732 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16733 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16734 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16735 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16736 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16737 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16738 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16739 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16740
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016741regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016742 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16743 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16744 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16745 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16746 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16747 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16748 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16749 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16750 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016751 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16752 of characters with other ones.
16753
16754 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16755 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16756 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16757 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16758 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16759 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016760
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016761 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016762
16763 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16764 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16765 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016766 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016767
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016768 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16769 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16770
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016771 # capture groups and backreferences
16772 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016773 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016774 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16775
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016776capture-req(<id>)
16777 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16778 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16779
16780 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016781 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16782 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016783
16784capture-res(<id>)
16785 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16786 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16787
16788 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016789 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16790 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016791
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016792rtrim(<chars>)
16793 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16794 of the input sample.
16795
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016796sdbm([<avalanche>])
16797 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16798 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16799 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16800 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16801 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16802 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16803 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016804 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16805 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016806
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016807secure_memcmp(<var>)
16808 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16809 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16810 match.
16811
16812 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16813 performed in constant time.
16814
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016815 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016816 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16817
16818 Example :
16819
16820 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16821 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16822 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16823 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16824
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016825set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016826 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16827 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16828 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016829 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016830 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16831 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016832 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016833 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16834 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016835 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016836 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016837
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016838sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016839 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016840 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16841
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016842sha2([<bits>])
16843 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16844 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16845
16846 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16847 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16848
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016849 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016850 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16851
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016852srv_queue
16853 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16854 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16855 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16856 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16857 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16858
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016859strcmp(<var>)
16860 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16861 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16862 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16863 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16864 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16865 shorter).
16866
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016867 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16868 strings in constant time.
16869
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016870 Example :
16871
16872 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16873 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16874 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16875
16876
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016877sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016878 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16879 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016880 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016881 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16882 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16885 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016886 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016887 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16888 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016889 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016890 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016891
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016892table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16893 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16894 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16895 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16896 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16897 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16898 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16899
16900
16901table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16902 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16903 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16904 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16905 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16906 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16907 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16908
16909table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016913 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16914 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16915
16916table_conn_cur(<table>)
16917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16920 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16921 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16922
16923table_conn_rate(<table>)
16924 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16925 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16926 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16927 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16928 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16929
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016930table_gpt0(<table>)
16931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16934 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16935 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16936
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016937table_gpc0(<table>)
16938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16940 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16941 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16942 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16943
16944table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16945 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16946 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16947 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16948 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16949 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16950 sample fetch keyword.
16951
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016952table_gpc1(<table>)
16953 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16954 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16955 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16956 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16957 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16958
16959table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16960 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16961 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16962 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16963 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16964 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16965 sample fetch keyword.
16966
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016967table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16968 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16969 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016970 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016971 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16972 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16973
16974table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16975 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16976 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16977 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16978 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16979 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16980 keyword.
16981
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016982table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16983 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16984 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16985 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16986 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16987 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16988
16989table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16992 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16993 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16994 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16995 keyword.
16996
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016997table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16998 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16999 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017000 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017001 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17002 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17003
17004table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17007 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17008 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17009 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17010 keyword.
17011
17012table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17013 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17014 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017015 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017016 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17017 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17018 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17019 keyword.
17020
17021table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17022 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17023 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017024 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017025 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17026 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17027 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17028 keyword.
17029
17030table_server_id(<table>)
17031 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17032 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17033 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17034 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17035 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17036 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17037
17038table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17039 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17040 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017041 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017042 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17043 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17044 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17045 keyword.
17046
17047table_sess_rate(<table>)
17048 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17049 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17050 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17051 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17052 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17053 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17054 keyword.
17055
17056table_trackers(<table>)
17057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17059 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17060 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17061 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17062 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17063 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17064 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17065 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17066 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17067
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017068ub64dec
17069 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17070 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17071 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17072
17073 Example:
17074 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17075 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17076
17077ub64enc
17078 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17079
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017080upper
17081 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17082 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17083 type. The result is of type string.
17084
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017085url_dec([<in_form>])
17086 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17087 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17088 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17089 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17090 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17091 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017092
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017093url_enc([<enc_type>])
17094 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17095 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17096 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17097 optional argument is here for future changes.
17098
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017099ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017100 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017101 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17102 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17103 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017104 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17105 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17106 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17107 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017108 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017109 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17110 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017111
17112 Example:
17113 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17114 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17115
17116 message Point {
17117 int32 latitude = 1;
17118 int32 longitude = 2;
17119 }
17120
17121 message PPoint {
17122 Point point = 59;
17123 }
17124
17125 message Rectangle {
17126 // One corner of the rectangle.
17127 PPoint lo = 48;
17128 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17129 PPoint hi = 49;
17130 }
17131
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017132 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17133 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17134 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017135
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017136 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17137 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017138 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017139 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17140
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017141 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017142
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017143 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017144
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017145 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17146 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17147 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017148
17149 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17150 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17151 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17152
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017153 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17154 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17155 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017156
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017157
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017158unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017159 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17160 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17161 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17162 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17163 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17164 response),
17165 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17166 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17167 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17168 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17169
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017170utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17171 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17172 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17173 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17174 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17175 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17176 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17177
17178 Example :
17179
17180 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017181 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017182 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17183
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017184word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17185 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17186 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17187 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017188 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017189 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17190 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17191
17192 Example :
17193 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17194 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17195 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17196 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17197 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017198 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017199
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017200wt6([<avalanche>])
17201 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17202 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17203 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17204 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17205 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17206 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17207 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017208 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17209 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017210
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017211xor(<value>)
17212 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017213 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017214 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017215 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017216 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017217 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17218 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017219 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017220 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17221 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017223 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017224
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017225xxh3([<seed>])
17226 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17227 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17228 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17229 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17230 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17231 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17232 considered as cryptographically secure.
17233
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017234xxh32([<seed>])
17235 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17236 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17237 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17238 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17239 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17240 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17241 as cryptographically secure.
17242
17243xxh64([<seed>])
17244 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17245 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17246 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17247 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17248 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17249 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17250 as cryptographically secure.
17251
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017252
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172537.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017254--------------------------------------------
17255
17256A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17257not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17258"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17259The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17260
17261always_false : boolean
17262 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17263 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17264
17265always_true : boolean
17266 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17267 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17268
17269avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017270 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17272 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17273 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17274 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17275 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17276 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17277 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17278 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17279 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17280 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17281 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17282 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17283 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017285be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017286 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17287 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17288 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17289 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017290 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17291
17292be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17293 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17294 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17295 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17296 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17297 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017298 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17299 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017300
17301 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17302 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17303 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017304
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017305be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17306 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17307 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17308 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017310 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17311 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017312
17313 Example :
17314 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17315 backend dynamic
17316 mode http
17317 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17318 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017319
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017320bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017321 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17322 of the string.
17323
17324bool(<bool>) : bool
17325 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17326 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017328connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17329 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017330 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17332 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017333
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017334 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017335 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017336 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17337
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017338 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17339 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017340
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017341 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017342 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017343 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017344 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017345 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017346 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017347 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017348
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017349 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17350 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017351 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017352 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017353
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017354cpu_calls : integer
17355 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17356 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17357 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17358 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17359 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17360 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17361
17362cpu_ns_avg : integer
17363 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17364 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17365 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17366 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17367 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17368 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17369 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17370 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17371 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17372 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17373 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17374
17375cpu_ns_tot : integer
17376 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17377 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17378 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17379 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17380 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17381 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17382 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17383 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17384 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17385 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17386 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17387 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17388 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17389
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017390date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017391 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017392
17393 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17394 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17395 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017396 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17397
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017398 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17399 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17400 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17401 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17402 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17403
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017404 Example :
17405
17406 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17407 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017408
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017409 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17410 # millisecond granularity
17411 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17412
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017413date_us : integer
17414 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17415 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17416 from the same timeval structure.
17417
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017418distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17419 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17420 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17421 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17422 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017423 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017424 list of supported tokens.
17425
17426distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17427 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17428 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17429 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17430 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017431 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017432 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17433 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17434 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17435 supported tokens.
17436
17437 Example :
17438 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17439 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17440 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17441 # send large files to the big farm
17442 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17443
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017444env(<name>) : string
17445 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17446 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17447 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17448 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17449 certain way.
17450
17451 Examples :
17452 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17453 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17454
17455 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017456 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017458fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17459 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017460 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17461 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17463 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017464 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017465 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17466 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017467
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017468fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17469 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17470 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17471 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017473fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17474 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17475 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17476 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17477 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17478 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17479 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17480 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17481 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017482
17483 Example :
17484 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17485 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17486 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17487 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17488 frontend mail
17489 bind :25
17490 mode tcp
17491 maxconn 100
17492 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17493 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17494 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17495 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017496
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017497hostname : string
17498 Returns the system hostname.
17499
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017500int(<integer>) : signed integer
17501 Returns a signed integer.
17502
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017503ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17504 Returns an ipv4.
17505
17506ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17507 Returns an ipv6.
17508
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017509lat_ns_avg : integer
17510 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17511 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17512 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17513 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17514 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17515 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17516 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17517 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17518 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017519 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17520 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17521 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17522 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17523 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17524 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017525
17526lat_ns_tot : integer
17527 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17528 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17529 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17530 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17531 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17532 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17533 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17534 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17535 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017536 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17537 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17538 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17539 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17540 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017541 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17542 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17543 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17544 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17545 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17546 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17547
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017548meth(<method>) : method
17549 Returns a method.
17550
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017551nbproc : integer
17552 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17553 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17554 and debugging purposes.
17555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17557 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17558 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17559 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017560 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17561 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17562 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017563
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017564prio_class : integer
17565 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17566 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17567 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17568
17569prio_offset : integer
17570 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17571 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17572 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17573 set-priority-offset".
17574
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017575proc : integer
17576 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17577 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17578 debugging purposes.
17579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017581 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17582 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17583 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017584 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17585 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17586 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17587 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17588 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17589
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017590rand([<range>]) : integer
17591 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17592 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17593 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17594 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17595 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017597srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17598 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17599 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17600 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17601 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17602 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017603 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17604 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17605
17606srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17607 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17608 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17609 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17610 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17611 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17612 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17613 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17614
17615 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17616 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617
17618srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17619 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17620 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17621 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017622 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017623 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17624 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17625 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17626
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017627srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17628 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17629 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17630 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17631 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17632 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17633 fetch methods.
17634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17636 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17637 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017638 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17640 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017641 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017642 overloading servers).
17643
17644 Example :
17645 # Redirect to a separate back
17646 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17647 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17648 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17649
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017650srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017651 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17652 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17653 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17654
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017655srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017656 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17657 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17658 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17659
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017660srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017661 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17662 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17663 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17664
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017665stopping : boolean
17666 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17667 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17668 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17669
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017670str(<string>) : string
17671 Returns a string.
17672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017673table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17674 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17675 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17676
17677table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17678 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17679 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17680 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17681
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017682thread : integer
17683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17684 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17685 and debugging purposes.
17686
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017687uuid([<version>]) : string
17688 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17689 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17690 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17691
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017692var(<var-name>) : undefined
17693 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017694 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17695 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017696 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017697 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17698 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017699 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017700 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17701 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017702 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017703 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017704
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200177057.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017706----------------------------------
17707
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017708The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017709closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17710methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17711sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17712TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017713the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17714counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017715"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17716used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17717can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17718Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17719table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17720tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17721currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017722
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017723bc_dst : ip
17724 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17725 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17726 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17727 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17728
17729bc_dst_port : integer
17730 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017731 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017732
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017733bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017734 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17735 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17736 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17737
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017738bc_src : ip
17739 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017740 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017741 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17742 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17743
17744bc_src_port : integer
17745 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017746 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017748be_id : integer
17749 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017750 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17751 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017752
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017753be_name : string
17754 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017755 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17756 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017757
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017758be_server_timeout : integer
17759 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17760 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17761 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17762
17763be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17764 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17765 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17766 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17767
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017768cur_server_timeout : integer
17769 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17770 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17771 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17772
17773cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17774 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17775 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17776 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017778dst : ip
17779 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17780 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17781 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17782 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017783 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17784 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17785 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17786 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17787 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17788 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017789
17790dst_conn : integer
17791 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17792 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17793 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17794 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17795 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17796 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17797 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17798 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017799
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017800dst_is_local : boolean
17801 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17802 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17803 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17804 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017805 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017806 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17807 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17808 it only once per connection.
17809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810dst_port : integer
17811 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17812 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17813 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17814 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17815 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17816 an HTTP header.
17817
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017818fc_fackets : integer
17819 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17820 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17821 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17822 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17823
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017824fc_http_major : integer
17825 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17826 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17827 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17828
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017829fc_lost : integer
17830 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17831 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17832 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17833 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17834
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017835fc_pp_authority : string
17836 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17837 if any.
17838
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017839fc_pp_unique_id : string
17840 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17841 if any.
17842
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017843fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17844 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17845 header.
17846
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017847fc_reordering : integer
17848 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17849 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17850 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17851 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17852
17853fc_retrans : integer
17854 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17855 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17856 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17857 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17858
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017859fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17860 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17861 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17862 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17863 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17864 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17865 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17866
17867fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17868 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17869 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17870 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17871 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17872 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17873 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17874
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017875fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017876 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17877 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17878 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17879 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17880
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017881
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017882fc_unacked : integer
17883 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17884 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17885 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17886 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017887
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017888fe_defbe : string
17889 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17890 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892fe_id : integer
17893 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017894 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017895 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17896
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017897fe_name : string
17898 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17899 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17900 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17901
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017902fe_client_timeout : integer
17903 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17904 current frontend.
17905
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017906sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017907sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17908sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17909sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017910 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17911 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17912 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17913
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017914sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017915sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17916sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17917sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017918 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17919 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17920 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17921
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017922sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017923sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17924sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17925sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017926 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17927 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017928 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17929 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17930 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017931
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017932 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017933 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17934 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017935 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17936 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17937 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017938 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17939 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17940
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017941sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17942sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17943sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17944sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17945 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17946 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17947 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17948 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17949 when a first ACL was verified.
17950
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017951sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017952sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17953sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17954sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017955 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017956 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17957
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017958sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017959sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17960sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17961sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017962 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17963 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17964 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17965
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017966sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017967sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17968sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17969sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017970 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17971 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17972 See also src_conn_rate.
17973
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017974sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017975sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17976sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17977sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017978 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017979 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017980
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017981sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17982sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17983sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17984sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17985 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17986 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17987
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017988sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17989sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17990sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17991sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17992 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17993 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17994
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017995sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017996sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17997sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17998sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017999 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18000 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18001 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018002 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18003 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18004 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018005
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018006sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18007sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18008sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18009sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18010 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18011 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18012 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18013 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18014 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18015 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018017sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018018sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18019sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18020sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018022 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18023 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18024
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018025sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018026sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18027sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18028sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018029 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18030 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18031 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18032 src_http_err_rate.
18033
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018034sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18035sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18036sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18037sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18038 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18039 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18040 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18041
18042sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18043sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18044sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18045sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18046 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18047 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18048 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18049 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18050
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018051sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018052sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18053sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18054sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018055 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018056 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18057 src_http_req_cnt.
18058
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018059sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018060sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18061sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18062sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018063 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18064 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18065 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18066 src_http_req_rate.
18067
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018068sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018069sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18070sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18071sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018072 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018073 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18074 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18075 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18076 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018077
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018078 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018079 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18080 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018081 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18082
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018083sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18084sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18085sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18086sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18087 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18088 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18089 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18090 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18091 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18092
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018093sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018094sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18095sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18096sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018097 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18098 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18099 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018100
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018101sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018102sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18103sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18104sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018105 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18106 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18107 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018108
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018109sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018110sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18111sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18112sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018113 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018114 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18115 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18116 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018117 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018118 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18119
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018120sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018121sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18122sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18123sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018124 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18125 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18126 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18127 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18128 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018129 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018130
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018131sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018132sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18133sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18134sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018135 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18136 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18137 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18138
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018139sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018140sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18141sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18142sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018143 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18144 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018145 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018146 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18147 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18149 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18150 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018152so_id : integer
18153 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18154 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18155 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018156
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018157so_name : string
18158 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18159 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18160 strings instead of integers.
18161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018163 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018164 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18165 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18166 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018167 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18168 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18169 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018170 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18171 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18172 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18173 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18174 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18175 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18176 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018177
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018178 Example:
18179 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18180 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018182src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18183 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18184 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18185 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018186 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018188src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18189 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18190 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018191 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018192 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018194src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18195 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18196 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18197 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18198 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18199 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18200 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018201
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018202 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018203 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18204 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18205 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18206 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018207 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018208 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18209 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18210
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018211src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18212 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18213 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18214 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18215 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18216 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18217 was verified.
18218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018220 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018222 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018223 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018225src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018226 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018227 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18228 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018229 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018231src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18232 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18233 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18234 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018235 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018237src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018238 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018240 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018241 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018242
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018243src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18244 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18245 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18246 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18247 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18248
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018249src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18250 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18251 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18252 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18253 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018256 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018257 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018258 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18259 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018260 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18261 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18262 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018263
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018264src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18265 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18266 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18267 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18268 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18269 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18270 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18271 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018273src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018274 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018275 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018276 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018277 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018278 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018280src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18281 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18282 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18283 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18284 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018285 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018286
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018287src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18288 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18289 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018290 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018291 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18292 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18293
18294src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18295 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18296 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18297 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18298 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18299 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18300 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018302src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018303 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018304 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18305 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018306 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018308src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18309 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18310 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18311 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018312 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018313 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018315src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18316 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18317 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18318 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018319 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018320 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18321 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018322
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018323 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018324 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018325 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018326 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018327
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018328src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18329 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18330 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18331 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18332 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18333 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18334 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18335
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018336src_is_local : boolean
18337 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18338 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18339 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18340 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018341 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018342 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18343 once per connection.
18344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018346 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18347 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18348 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18349 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18350 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018352src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018353 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18354 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18355 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18356 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18357 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018359src_port : integer
18360 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18361 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18362 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18363 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018365src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018366 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018367 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18368 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18369 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018370 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18373 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18374 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18375 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18376 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018377 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018379src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18380 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18381 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18382 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18383 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18384 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18385 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18386 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18387 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018388
18389 Example :
18390 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18391 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18392 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18393 listen ssh
18394 bind :22
18395 mode tcp
18396 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018397 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018398 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018399 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018401srv_id : integer
18402 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18403 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018404 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018405
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018406srv_name : string
18407 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18408 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018409 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018410
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184117.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018413
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018414The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18416when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18417usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018418future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018419
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001842051d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18421 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18422 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18423 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18424 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18425 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18426
18427 Example :
18428 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18429 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18430 # the request.
18431 frontend http-in
18432 bind *:8081
18433 default_backend servers
18434 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18435 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18436
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018437ssl_bc : boolean
18438 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18439 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018440 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18441 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018442
18443ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18444 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018445 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18446 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018447
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018448ssl_bc_alpn : string
18449 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18450 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018451 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018452 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18453 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18454 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18455 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18456 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018457 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18458 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018459
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018460ssl_bc_cipher : string
18461 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018462 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18463 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018464
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018465ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18466 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18467 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18468 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018469 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018470
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018471ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18472 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18473 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018474 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18475 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018476
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018477ssl_bc_npn : string
18478 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18479 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018480 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018481 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18482 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18483 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18484 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018485 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18486 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018487
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018488ssl_bc_protocol : string
18489 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018490 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18491 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018492
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018493ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018494 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018495 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018496 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18497 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018498
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018499ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18500 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18501 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18502 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018503 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018504
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018505ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18506 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18507 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018508 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18509 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018510
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018511ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18512 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18513 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18514 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018515 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018516
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018517ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18518 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018519 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18520 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018522ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18523 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18524 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18525 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18526 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18527 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018529ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18530 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18531 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18532 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18533 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018534
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018535ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018536 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18537 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18538 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018539 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018540 does not support resumed sessions.
18541
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018542ssl_c_der : binary
18543 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18544 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18545 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018547ssl_c_err : integer
18548 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18549 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18550 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18551 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18552 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018553
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018554ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018555 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18556 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18557 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18558 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18559 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18560 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18561 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18562 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018563 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18564 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18565 LDAP v3.
18566 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18567 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018569ssl_c_key_alg : string
18570 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18571 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18572 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018573
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018574ssl_c_notafter : string
18575 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18576 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18577 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018579ssl_c_notbefore : string
18580 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18581 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18582 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018583
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018584ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18586 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18587 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18588 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18589 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18590 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18591 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18592 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018593 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18594 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18595 LDAP v3.
18596 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18597 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599ssl_c_serial : binary
18600 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18601 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18602 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18605 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18606 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18607 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018608 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18609 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18610
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018611 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018612 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018614ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18615 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18616 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18617 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018619ssl_c_used : boolean
18620 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18621 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623ssl_c_verify : integer
18624 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18625 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18626 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18627 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018629ssl_c_version : integer
18630 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18631 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018632
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018633ssl_f_der : binary
18634 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18635 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18636 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18637
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018638ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018639 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18640 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18641 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18642 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018643 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018644 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18645 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18646 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018647 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18648 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18649 LDAP v3.
18650 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18651 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653ssl_f_key_alg : string
18654 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18655 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18656 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018658ssl_f_notafter : string
18659 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18660 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18661 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018663ssl_f_notbefore : string
18664 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18665 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18666 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018667
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018668ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018669 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18670 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18671 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18672 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18673 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18674 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18675 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18676 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018677 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18678 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18679 LDAP v3.
18680 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18681 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683ssl_f_serial : binary
18684 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18685 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18686 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018687
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018688ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18689 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18690 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18691 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018693ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18694 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18695 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18696 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018698ssl_f_version : integer
18699 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18700 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18701
18702ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018703 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18704 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18705 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018707 Example :
18708 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18709 listen http-https
18710 bind :80
18711 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18712 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18713
18714ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18715 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18716 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18717
18718ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018719 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018720 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018721 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018722 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18723 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18724 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18725 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18726 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18727 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729ssl_fc_cipher : string
18730 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18731 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018732
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018733ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18734 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18735 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018736 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018737
18738ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18739 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18740 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018741 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018742
18743ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18744 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18745 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18746 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018747 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018748 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018749
18750ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18751 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18752 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018753 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018754
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018755ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18756 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18757 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18758 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18759
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018760ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18761 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18762 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18763 transport layer.
18764 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18765 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18766 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18767 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18768
18769ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18770 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18771 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18772 transport layer.
18773 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18774 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18775 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18776 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18777
18778ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18779 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18780 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18781 transport layer.
18782 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18783 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18784 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18785 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18786
18787ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18788 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18789 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18790 transport layer.
18791 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18792 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18793 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18794 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18795
18796ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18797 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18798 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18799 transport layer.
18800 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18801 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18802 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18803 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018805ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018806 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18807 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018808 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18809 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18810 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18811 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018812
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018813ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18814 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18815 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18816 wait until the handshake happened.
18817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018818ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18819 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018820 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18821 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018822 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018823 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018824
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018825ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018826 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018827 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18828 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018830ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018831 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018832 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018833 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18834 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18835 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18836 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18837 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18838 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018840ssl_fc_protocol : string
18841 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18842 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018843
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018844ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018845 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018846 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018847 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018848
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018849ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18850 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18851 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18852 transport layer.
18853 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18854 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18855 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18856 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18857
18858ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18859 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18860 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18861 transport layer.
18862 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18863 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18864 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18865 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18866
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018867ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18868 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18869 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18870 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18873 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18874 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18875 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18876 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018877
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018878ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18879 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18880 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18881 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18882 BoringSSL.
18883
18884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018885ssl_fc_sni : string
18886 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18887 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018888 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018889 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18890 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18891
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018892 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018893 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018894 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018895 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018896 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018897
Willy Tarreau000d4002022-11-25 10:12:12 +010018898 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
18899 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
18900 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
18901 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
18902 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
18903 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
18904 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
18905 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
18906 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
18907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018908 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018909 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18910 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018912ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18913 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18914 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018915
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018916ssl_s_der : binary
18917 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18918 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18919 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18920
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018921ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18922 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18923 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18924 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018925 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018926 does not support resumed sessions.
18927
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018928ssl_s_key_alg : string
18929 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18930 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18931 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18932
18933ssl_s_notafter : string
18934 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18935 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18936 transport layer.
18937
18938ssl_s_notbefore : string
18939 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18940 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18941 transport layer.
18942
18943ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18944 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18945 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18946 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18947 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18948 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18949 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018950 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18951 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018952 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18953 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18954 LDAP v3.
18955 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18956 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18957
18958ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18959 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18960 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18961 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18962 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18963 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18964 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018965 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18966 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018967 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18968 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18969 LDAP v3.
18970 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18971 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18972
18973ssl_s_serial : binary
18974 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18975 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18976 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18977
18978ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18979 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18980 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18981 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18982
18983ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18984 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18985 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18986 layer.
18987
18988ssl_s_version : integer
18989 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18990 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018991
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018993------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018995Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18996sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18997only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18998For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18999be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19000can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19001sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19002for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19003content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019004
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019005Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19006 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019007 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019008 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19009 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19010 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19011 sample expression). So be careful.
19012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019013payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019014 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19016 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019018payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19019 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019020 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019021 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019023req.len : integer
19024req_len : integer (deprecated)
19025 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19026 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19027 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19028 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19029 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019030 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019031 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19032 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019034req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19035 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019036 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19037 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19038 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19039 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019040
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019041 ACL derivatives :
19042 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19045 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19046 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19047 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19048 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019049
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019050 ACL derivatives :
19051 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019053 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019055req.proto_http : boolean
19056req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19057 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19058 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19059 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19060 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19061 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19062 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19063 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019065 Example:
19066 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19067 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19068 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019069 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019071req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19072rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19073 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19074 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19075 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19076 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19077 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19078 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19079 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019081 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19082 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19083 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19084 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19085 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19086 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019088 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019089 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091 Example :
19092 listen tse-farm
19093 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19094 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19095 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19096 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19097 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19098 persist rdp-cookie
19099 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19100 # This is only useful makes sense if
19101 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19102 stick-table type string size 204800
19103 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19104 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19105 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019107 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019108 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019109
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019110req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19111rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19112 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19113 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19114 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19115 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019117 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019118 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019119
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019120req.ssl_alpn : string
19121 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19122 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19123 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19124 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19125 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19126 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019127 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019128
19129 Examples :
19130 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19131 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019132 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019133 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019134 default_backend bk_default
19135
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019136req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19137 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19138 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019139 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19140 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19141 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19142 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19143 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019145req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19146req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19147 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19148 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19149 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19150 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19151 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19152 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19153 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019155req.ssl_sni : string
19156req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19157 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19158 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19159 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19160 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19161 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019162 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19163 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19164 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19165 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19166 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19167 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19168 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19169 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19170 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019172 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019173 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019175 Examples :
19176 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19177 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019178 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019179 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019180 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019181
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019182req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19183 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19184 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19185 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19186 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19187 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19188 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19189 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19190 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19191 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019193req.ssl_ver : integer
19194req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19195 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19196 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19197 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19198 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19199 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19200 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19201 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019202 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019205 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019206 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019207
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019208res.len : integer
19209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19210 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19211 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19212 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19213 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019214 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019215 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019216 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019218res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19219 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019220 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019221 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019222 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019223 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19226 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19227 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19228 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019229 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19230 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019233
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019234res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19235rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19236 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19237 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19238 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19239 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19240 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19241 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19242 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019244wait_end : boolean
19245 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19246 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019247 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19249 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019250 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19252 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019253
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019254 Examples :
19255 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19256 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19257 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19260 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19261 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19262 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19263 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19264 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19265 tcp-request content reject
19266
19267
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192687.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019269--------------------------------------
19270
19271It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19272This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19273data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19274its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19275HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19276content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19277to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19278more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19279response are indexed.
19280
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019281Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19282 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19283 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19284 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19285 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19286 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19287 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019289base : string
19290 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19291 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19292 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19293 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19294 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19295 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19296 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19297 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19298
19299 ACL derivatives :
19300 base : exact string match
19301 base_beg : prefix match
19302 base_dir : subdir match
19303 base_dom : domain match
19304 base_end : suffix match
19305 base_len : length match
19306 base_reg : regex match
19307 base_sub : substring match
19308
19309base32 : integer
19310 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19311 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19312 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019313 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19314 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19315 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019316
19317base32+src : binary
19318 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19319 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19320 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19321 per-URL counters.
19322
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019323baseq : string
19324 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19325 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19326 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19327 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19328
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019329capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19330 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19331 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19332 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19333
19334capture.req.method : string
19335 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19336 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19337 because it's allocated.
19338
19339capture.req.uri : string
19340 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19341 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19342 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19343 allocated.
19344
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019345capture.req.ver : string
19346 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19347 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19348 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19349
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019350capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19351 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19352 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19353 The first entry is an index of 0.
19354 See also: "capture response header"
19355
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019356capture.res.ver : string
19357 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19358 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19359 persistent flag.
19360
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019361req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019362 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19363 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19364 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019365
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019366req.body_param([<name>) : string
19367 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19368 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19369 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19370 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19371 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19372 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19373 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19374 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19375 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19376 given.
19377
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019378req.body_len : integer
19379 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19380 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019381 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19382 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019383
19384req.body_size : integer
19385 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019386 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19387 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389req.cook([<name>]) : string
19390cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19391 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19392 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19393 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19394 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19395 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19396 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19397 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19398 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19399
19400 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019401 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19402 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19403 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19404 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19405 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19406 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19407 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19408 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19411cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19412 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19413 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019414
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019415req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19416cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19417 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19418 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19419 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19420 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019422cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19423 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19424 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19425 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19426 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019427 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19429 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19430 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19431 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019433hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19434 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19435 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19436 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19437 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019438 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019441 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19442 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19443 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19444 with headers such as User-Agent.
19445
19446 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19447 found.
19448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19450 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19451 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019452 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019454req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19455 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19456 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019457 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19458 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019460req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019461 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19462 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19463 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19464 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19465 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19466 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19467 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19468
19469 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19470 found.
19471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019472 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19473 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19474 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019475 with -1 being the last one.
19476
19477 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19478 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019480 ACL derivatives :
19481 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19482 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19483 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19484 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19485 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19486 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19487 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19488 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19489
19490req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19491hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19492 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19493 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019494 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19495 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19496 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19497
19498 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19499 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19500 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19501
19502 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503
19504req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19505hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19506 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19507 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19508 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019509 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19510 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19511 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19512 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19513 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019514
19515 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19516
19517 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019518
19519req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19520hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19521 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19522 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19523 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019524
19525 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19526
19527 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019528
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019529req.hdrs : string
19530 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19531 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19532 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19533 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19534
19535req.hdrs_bin : binary
19536 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19537 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19538 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19539 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19540 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19541 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19542
19543 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019544
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019545 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19546 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19549 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19550 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19551 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19552 basic auth is supported.
19553
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019554http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19555 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19556 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19557 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19558 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019559 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19560 basic auth is supported.
19561
19562 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019563 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19564 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19565 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19566 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019567
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019568http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019569 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19570 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19571 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019572
19573http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019574 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19575 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19576 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019577
19578http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019579 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19580 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19581 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019583http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019584 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19585 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019586 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19587 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019589method : integer + string
19590 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19591 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19592 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19593 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19594 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19595 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19596 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019597
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019598 ACL derivatives :
19599 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019601 Example :
19602 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19603 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19604 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019606path : string
19607 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19608 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19609 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19610 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19611 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019612 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019613 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019615 ACL derivatives :
19616 path : exact string match
19617 path_beg : prefix match
19618 path_dir : subdir match
19619 path_dom : domain match
19620 path_end : suffix match
19621 path_len : length match
19622 path_reg : regex match
19623 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019624
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019625pathq : string
19626 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19627 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19628 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19629 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19630 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19631 result in both cases.
19632
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019633query : string
19634 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19635 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19636 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19637 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019638 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019639 which stops before the question mark.
19640
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019641req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19642 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19643 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19644 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19645 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019647req.ver : string
19648req_ver : string (deprecated)
19649 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19650 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19651 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019653 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019654 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019655
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019656res.body : binary
19657 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19658 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019659 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19660
19661 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019662
19663res.body_len : integer
19664 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19665 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019666 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19667
19668 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019669
19670res.body_size : integer
19671 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19672 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19673 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19674 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019675 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19676
19677 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019678
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019679res.cache_hit : boolean
19680 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19681 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19682
19683res.cache_name : string
19684 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19685 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19686 empty string.
19687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688res.comp : boolean
19689 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19690 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19691 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019693res.comp_algo : string
19694 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19695 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19696 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019698res.cook([<name>]) : string
19699scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19700 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19701 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019702 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19703
19704 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019706 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019707 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019709res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19710scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19711 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19712 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019713 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19714
19715 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19718scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19719 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19720 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019721 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19722
19723 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019725res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019726 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19727 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19728
19729 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19730 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19731
19732 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19733
19734 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019736res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019737 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19738 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19739
19740 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19741 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19742
19743 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019745res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19746shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019747 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19748 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19749
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019750 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019751 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19752
19753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019755 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019756 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19757 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19758 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19759 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19760 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19761 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19762 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19763 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764
19765res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19766shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019767 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19768 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19769
19770 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019771 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019772
19773 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019775res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19776shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019777 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19778 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19779
19780 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19781
19782 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019783
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019784res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19785 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19786 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19787 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019788 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19789
19790 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019792res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19793shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019794 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19795 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19796
19797 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19798
19799 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019800
19801res.hdrs : string
19802 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19803 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19804 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019805 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19806
19807 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019808
19809res.hdrs_bin : binary
19810 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19811 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19812 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19813 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19814 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19815 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19816 (length of 0 for both).
19817
19818 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19819
19820 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19821 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823res.ver : string
19824resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19825 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019826 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19827
19828 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019830 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019831 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019833set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19834 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19835 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019836 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019837 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019839 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19840 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019842status : integer
19843 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19844 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019845 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19846
19847 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019848
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019849unique-id : string
19850 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19851 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19852 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19853 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19854 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19855 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019857url : string
19858 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19859 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19860 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19861 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19862 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19863 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19864 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866 ACL derivatives :
19867 url : exact string match
19868 url_beg : prefix match
19869 url_dir : subdir match
19870 url_dom : domain match
19871 url_end : suffix match
19872 url_len : length match
19873 url_reg : regex match
19874 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876url_ip : ip
19877 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19878 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19879 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19880 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19881 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19882 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19883 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019885url_port : integer
19886 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19887 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19888 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19889 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019890
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019891urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19892url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19894 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019895 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19896 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19897 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19898 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019899 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19900 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019901 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19902 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019904 ACL derivatives :
19905 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19906 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19907 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19908 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19909 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19910 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19911 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19912 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019913
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019915 Example :
19916 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19917 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19918 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19919 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019920
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019921urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19923 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19924 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019925
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019926url32 : integer
19927 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19928 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19929 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19930 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19931 is an unsigned integer.
19932
19933url32+src : binary
19934 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19935 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19936 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19937
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019938
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200199397.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019940---------------------------------------
19941
19942This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19943used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19944purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19945There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19946or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19947any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19948for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19949
19950internal.htx.data : integer
19951 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19952 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19953
19954internal.htx.free : integer
19955 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19956 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19957
19958internal.htx.free_data : integer
19959 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19960 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19961
19962internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019963 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19964 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19965 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019966
19967internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19968 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19969 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19970
19971internal.htx.size : integer
19972 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19973 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19974
19975internal.htx.used : integer
19976 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19977 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19978 direction.
19979
19980internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19981 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19982 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19983 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19984 of the special value :
19985 * head : The oldest inserted block
19986 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019987 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019988
19989internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19990 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19991 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19992 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19993 integer or one of the special value :
19994 * head : The oldest inserted block
19995 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019996 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019997
19998internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19999 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20000 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20001 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20002 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20003
20004 * head : The oldest inserted block
20005 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020006 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020007
20008internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20009 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20010 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20011 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20012 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20013
20014 * head : The oldest inserted block
20015 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020016 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020017
20018internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20019 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20020 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20021 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20022 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20023
20024 * head : The oldest inserted block
20025 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020026 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020027
20028internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20029 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20030 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20031 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20032 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20033
20034 * head : The oldest inserted block
20035 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020036 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020037
20038internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20039 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20040 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20041 it returns false.
20042
20043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200447.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020045---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020046
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020047Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20048every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020049order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020051ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020052---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20053FALSE always_false never match
20054HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20055HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20056HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020057HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020058HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20059HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20060HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20061HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20062LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20063METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20064METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20065METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20066METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20067METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20068METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20069METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20070METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20071RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20072REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20073TRUE always_true always match
20074WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20075---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020076
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200788. Logging
20079----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020080
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020081One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20082provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20083very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20084provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20085state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020086to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020087headers.
20088
20089In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20090about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20091send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20092
20093 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20094 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20095 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20096 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20097 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020098 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020099 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020100
20101The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20102allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20103as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20104while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20105real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20106delay.
20107
20108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201098.1. Log levels
20110---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020111
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020112TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020113source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020114HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20115in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20116track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20117syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20118about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020119
20120
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201218.2. Log formats
20122----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020123
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020124HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020125and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20126slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20127options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020128
20129 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20130 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20131 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20132 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20133 extents.
20134
20135 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20136 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20137 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20138 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20139 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20140
20141 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20142 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20143 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20144 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20145 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20146
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020147 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20148 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20149 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20150 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20151
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020152 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20153
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020154Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20155specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20156field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20157servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20158always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20159identifier.
20160
20161Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20162 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20163 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20164 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20165 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20166
20167
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201688.2.1. Default log format
20169-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020170
20171This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20172as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20173format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20174
20175 Example :
20176 listen www
20177 mode http
20178 log global
20179 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20180
20181 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20182 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20183 (www/HTTP)
20184
20185 Field Format Extract from the example above
20186 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20187 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20188 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20189 4 'to' to
20190 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20191 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20192
20193Detailed fields description :
20194 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20195 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20196 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20197 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20198 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20199 and processed the connection.
20200 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20201
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020202In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20203"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20204connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20205
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020206It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20207will eventually disappear.
20208
20209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202108.2.2. TCP log format
20211---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020212
20213The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20214is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20215information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20216counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20217emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20218environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20219the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20220sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020221specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20222not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20223fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20224marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020225
20226 Example :
20227 frontend fnt
20228 mode tcp
20229 option tcplog
20230 log global
20231 default_backend bck
20232
20233 backend bck
20234 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20235
20236 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20237 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20238 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20239
20240 Field Format Extract from the example above
20241 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20242 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20243 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20244 4 frontend_name fnt
20245 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20246 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20247 7 bytes_read* 212
20248 8 termination_state --
20249 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20250 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20251
20252Detailed fields description :
20253 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020254 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020255 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20256 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020257 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020258 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020259 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020260
20261 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020262 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20263 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20264 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020265
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020266 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20268 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020269 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20270 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20271 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20272 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020273
20274 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20275 and processed the connection.
20276
20277 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20278 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20279 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20280 applications.
20281
20282 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20283 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20284 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20285 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20286 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20287
20288 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20289 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20290 See "Timers" below for more details.
20291
20292 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20293 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20294 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20295 "Timers" below for more details.
20296
20297 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020298 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020299 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20300 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20301 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20302 details.
20303
20304 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20305 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20306 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20307 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20308 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20309
20310 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20311 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20312 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20313 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20314 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20315 for more details.
20316
20317 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020318 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020319 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20320 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20321 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020322 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020323
20324 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20325 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20326 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20327 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20328 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20329 caused by a denial of service attack.
20330
20331 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20332 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20333 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20334 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20335 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20336 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20337 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20338 denial of service attack.
20339
20340 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20341 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20342 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20343 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20344 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20345 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20346 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20347 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20348 be processed than on other servers.
20349
20350 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20351 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20352 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20353 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020354 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020355 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20356 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20357 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20358 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20359 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20360 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20361 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20362 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20363
20364 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20365 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20366 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20367 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20368 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20369 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020370 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020371 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20372
20373 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20374 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20375 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20376 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20377 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20378 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020379 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020380 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20381 occurs.
20382
20383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203848.2.3. HTTP log format
20385----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386
20387The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20388is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20389the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20390are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20391emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20392generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20393"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20394which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020395frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20396is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020397
20398Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20399slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20400with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20401
20402 Example :
20403 frontend http-in
20404 mode http
20405 option httplog
20406 log global
20407 default_backend bck
20408
20409 backend static
20410 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20411
20412 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20413 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20414 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020415 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020416
20417 Field Format Extract from the example above
20418 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20419 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020420 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020421 4 frontend_name http-in
20422 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020423 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020424 7 status_code 200
20425 8 bytes_read* 2750
20426 9 captured_request_cookie -
20427 10 captured_response_cookie -
20428 11 termination_state ----
20429 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20430 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20431 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20432 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20433 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020434
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020435Detailed fields description :
20436 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020437 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020438 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20439 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020440 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020441 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020442 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020443
20444 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020445 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20446 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20447 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020448
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020449 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020450 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020451
20452 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20453 and processed the connection.
20454
20455 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20456 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20457 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20458
20459 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20460 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20461 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20462 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20463 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20464 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20465
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020466 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20467 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20468 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020469 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020470 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20471 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020472 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020473 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020474
20475 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20476 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020477 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020478
20479 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20480 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020481 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20482 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020483
20484 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20485 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20486 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20487 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20488 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020489 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20490 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020491
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020492 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020493 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20494 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20495 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20496 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20497 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20498 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020499 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500
20501 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020502 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20503 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020504
20505 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20506 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020507 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020508 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20509 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20510 overflowing.
20511
20512 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20513 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20514 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20515 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20516 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20517 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20518 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20519 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20520
20521 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20522 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20523 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20524 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20525 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20526 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20527 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20528 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20529
20530 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20531 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20532 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20533 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20534 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20535 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20536 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20537
20538 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020539 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020540 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20541 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20542 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020543 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020544 system.
20545
20546 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20547 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20548 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20549 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20550 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20551 caused by a denial of service attack.
20552
20553 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20554 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20555 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20556 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20557 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20558 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20559 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20560 denial of service attack.
20561
20562 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20563 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20564 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20565 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20566 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20567 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20568 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20569 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20570 processed than on other servers.
20571
20572 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20573 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20574 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20575 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020576 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020577 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20578 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20579 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20580 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20581 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20582 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20583 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20584 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20585
20586 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20587 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20588 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20589 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20590 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20591 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020592 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020593 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20594
20595 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20596 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20597 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20598 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20599 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20600 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020601 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020602 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20603 occurs.
20604
20605 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20606 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20607 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20608 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20609 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20610 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20611 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20612 cookies" below for more details.
20613
20614 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20615 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20616 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20617 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20618 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20619 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20620 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20621 and cookies" below for more details.
20622
20623 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20624 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20625 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20626 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20627 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20628 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20629 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20630 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20631
20632
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200206338.2.4. Custom log format
20634------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020635
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020636The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020637mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020638
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020639HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020640Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20641separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20642prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20643
20644Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20645variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020646("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020647
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020648If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020649as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020650less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20651the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20652
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020653Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20654"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20655delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20656preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020657
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020658Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20659'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20660https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20661such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20662
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020663Flags are :
20664 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020665 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020666 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20667 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020668
20669 Example:
20670
20671 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20672 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20673
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020674 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20675
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020676At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020678 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20679 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020680
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020681the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020683 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20684 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20685 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020686
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020687and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20688
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020689 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20690 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020691
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020692Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20693
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020694 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020695 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020696 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20697 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20698 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020699 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20700 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20701 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020702 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020703 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020704 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020705 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020706 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020707 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20708 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020709 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020710 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020711 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020712 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020713 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020714 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020715 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020716 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20717 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20718 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20719 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20720 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020721 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020722 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020723 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020724 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020725 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020726 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20727 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020728 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20729 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20730 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020731 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020732 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20733 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020734 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020735 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20736 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20737 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020738 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020739 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020740 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20741 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20742 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20743 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020744 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020745 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020746 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020747 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020748 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020749 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020750 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20751 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20752 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020753 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020754 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20755 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020756 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020757 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20758 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020759 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020760 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020761 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020762 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020763
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020764 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020765
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020766
207678.2.5. Error log format
20768-----------------------
20769
20770When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020771protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020772By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20773"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020774will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020775logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20776
20777The format looks like this :
20778
20779 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20780 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20781 Connection error during SSL handshake
20782
20783 Field Format Extract from the example above
20784 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20785 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20786 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20787 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20788 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20789
20790These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20791failures.
20792
20793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207948.3. Advanced logging options
20795-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020796
20797Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20798just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20799options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20800for more information about their usage.
20801
20802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20804------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020805
20806It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020807HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020808commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20809monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20810ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20811
20812 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20813 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20814 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20815 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20816
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020817 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20818 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020819
20820 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20821 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20822 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20823
20824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208258.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20826----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020827
20828The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20829what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20830or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020831"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020832just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20833log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20834after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20835is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20836with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20837with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20838
20839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208408.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20841------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020842
20843Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20844for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20845"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20846retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20847raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20848a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20849file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20850you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20851"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20852
20853
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208548.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20855--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020856
20857Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20858multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20859them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20860"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20861logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20862error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20863and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20864too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20865useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20866alternative.
20867
20868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208698.4. Timing events
20870------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020871
20872Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20873reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20874the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20875frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020876mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20877addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20878
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020879Timings events in HTTP mode:
20880
20881 first request 2nd request
20882 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20883 t tr t tr ...
20884 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20885 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20886 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20887 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020888 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020889 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20890
20891Timings events in TCP mode:
20892
20893 TCP session
20894 |<----------------->|
20895 t t
20896 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20897 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20898 |<------ Tt ------->|
20899
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020900 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020901 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020902 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20903 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20904 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020905 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020906 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20907 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20908 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20909 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020910
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020911 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20912 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20913 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020914 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20915 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20916 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20917 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20918 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20919 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020920
20921 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20922 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20923 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20924 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20925 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20926 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20927 request typed by hand during a test.
20928
20929 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20930 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020931 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020932 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20933 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20934 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20935 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936
20937 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20938 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20939 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20940 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20941 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20942
20943 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20944 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20945 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20946 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20947 connection never established.
20948
20949 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20950 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20951 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20952 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20953 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20954 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20955 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20956 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20957 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20958 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20959 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20960
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020961 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20962 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20963 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20964 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20965 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20966 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20967
20968 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20969
20970 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20971 "Ta" can never be negative.
20972
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020973 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20974 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020975 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20976 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020977 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020978
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020979 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020980
20981 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020982 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20983 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020984
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020985 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20986 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20987 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20988 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20989 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20990 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20991 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20992 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20993
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020994These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20995protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20996that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020997due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20998"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20999that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021000
21001Most common cases :
21002
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021003 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21004 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21005 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21006 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21007 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021008 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021009 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21010 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21011 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21012 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21013 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021014 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021015
21016 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21017 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21018 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21019 of ms on remote networks.
21020
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021021 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21022 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21023 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021025 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21026 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021027 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021028 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21029 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21030 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21031 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21032 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21033 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021034
21035Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21036
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021037 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021038 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021039 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021040
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021041 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021042 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21043 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021045 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021046 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21047 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21048 flags.
21049
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021050 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21051 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021052 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21053 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21054 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21055 the client connection was maintained open.
21056
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021057 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021058 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021059 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021060 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21061
21062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210638.5. Session state at disconnection
21064-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021065
21066TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21067"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210682-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21069each of which has a special meaning :
21070
21071 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21072 session to terminate :
21073
21074 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21075
21076 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21077 server explicitly refused it.
21078
21079 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21080 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21081 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21082 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021083 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021084
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021085 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021086 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021087
21088 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21089 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21090 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21091 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21092 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21093
21094 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21095 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21096 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21097 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21098 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021100 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021101 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21102
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021103 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021104 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21105 backup connections when going up.
21106
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021107 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021108
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021109 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21110 send or receive data.
21111
21112 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21113 send or receive data.
21114
21115 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21116 with nothing left in the buffers.
21117
21118 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21119
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021120 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021121 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21122
21123 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21124 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21125 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21126 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21127 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21128
21129 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21130 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21131
21132 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21133 server (HTTP only).
21134
21135 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21136
21137 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21138 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21139 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21140
21141 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21142 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21143 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21144
21145 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21146
21147 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21148 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21149
21150 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21151 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21152 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21153
21154 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21155 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021156 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21157 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021158
21159 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21160 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21161 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21162 another server.
21163
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021164 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165 server.
21166
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021167 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21168 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21169 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21170 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21171
21172 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21173 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21174 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21175 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21176
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021177 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21178 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21179 "use-server" rule).
21180
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021181 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21182
21183 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21184 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21185
21186 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21187
21188 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21189 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21190 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21191
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021192 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21193 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021194 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021195 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21196 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21197
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021198 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21199
21200 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21201 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21202
21203 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21204
21205 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21206
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021207The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21208was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021209helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21210starvation, attacks, etc...
21211
21212The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21213alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21214easier finding and understanding.
21215
21216 Flags Reason
21217
21218 -- Normal termination.
21219
21220 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021221 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21222 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021223 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21224
21225 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21226 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021227 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21228 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021229 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21230 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021232 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21233 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021234 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021235
21236 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21237 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21238 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21239
21240 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21241 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21242 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21243 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21244 the server takes too long to respond.
21245
21246 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21247 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21248 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21249 long a time to respond.
21250
21251 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21252 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21253 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021254 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021255 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21256 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021257
21258 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21259 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21260 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21261 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21262 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021263 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021264 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21265 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21266 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21267 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21268 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21269 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21270 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21271 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021272 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021273 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21274 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21275 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021276
21277 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21278 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021279 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21280 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21281 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21282 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021283
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021284 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021285 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21286
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021287 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021288 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21289 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021290 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021291 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21292 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21293
21294 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21295 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21296 503 or 504 here.
21297
21298 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021299 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021300 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21301 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21302 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21303
21304 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21305 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021306 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021307 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021308 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021309
21310 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21311 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21312 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21313 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21314 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21315 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021316 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021317
21318 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21319 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21320 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21321 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21322 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21323 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21324 solution is to fix the application.
21325
21326 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21327 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21328 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21329 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21330 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21331 external attacks.
21332
21333 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021334 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021335 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021336 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21337 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21338
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021339 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21340 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21341 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021342 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021343 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021344
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021345 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21346 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21347 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21348 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021349 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21350 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21351 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21352 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021353 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21354 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21355 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21356 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021357
21358 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21359 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21360 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021361 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21362 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21363 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21364 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021365
21366 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21367 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21368 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21369 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21370
21371 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21372 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21373 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21374 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21375
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021376The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021377persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021378important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21379re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21380
21381 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21382
21383 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21384 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21385 set on a GET request.
21386
21387 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21388 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021389 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021390 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21391
21392 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21393 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21394 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21395
21396 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21397 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21398 already got a cookie.
21399
21400 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21401 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21402 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21403 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21404 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21405
21406 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21407 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21408 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21409
21410 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21411 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21412 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21413
21414 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21415 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21416
21417 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21418 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21419 then advertised in the response.
21420
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214228.6. Non-printable characters
21423-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021424
21425In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21426consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21427converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21428prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21429being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21430escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21431is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21432'}' when logging headers.
21433
21434Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21435issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21436containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21437
21438Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21439the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21440performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21441
21442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214438.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21444---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021445
21446Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21447achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021448section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021449cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21450the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21451the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021452locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021453not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21454user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21455a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21456wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21457
21458 Examples :
21459 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21460 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21461
21462 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21463 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21464
21465
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214668.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21467---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021468
21469Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21470proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21471the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21472server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21473
21474Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21475response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021476section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021477
21478It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021479time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21480appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021481are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21482and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21483follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21484request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21485in the logs.
21486
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021487As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21488frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21489an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21490
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021491 Example :
21492 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21493 listen proxy-out
21494 mode http
21495 option httplog
21496 option logasap
21497 log global
21498 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21499
21500 # log the name of the virtual server
21501 capture request header Host len 20
21502
21503 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21504 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21505
21506 # log the beginning of the referrer
21507 capture request header Referer len 20
21508
21509 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21510 capture response header Server len 20
21511
21512 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21513 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21514
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021515 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021516 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21517
21518 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21519 capture response header Via len 20
21520
21521 # log the URL location during a redirection
21522 capture response header Location len 20
21523
21524 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21525 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21526 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21527 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21528 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21529
21530 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21531 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21532 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21533 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021534 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021535
21536 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21537 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21538 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21539 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21540 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021541 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021542
21543
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215448.9. Examples of logs
21545---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021546
21547These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21548them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21549reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21550
21551 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21552 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21553 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21554
21555 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21556 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21557
21558 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21559 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21560 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21561
21562 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21563 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21564
21565 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21566 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21567 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21568
21569 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021570 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021571 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21572 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21573
21574 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21575 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21576 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21577
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021578 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21579 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21580 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21581 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021582 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021583 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021584
21585 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021586 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021587
21588 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21589 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21590 Nothing was sent to any server.
21591
21592 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21593 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21594
21595 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21596 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021597 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021598 send a 408 return code to the client.
21599
21600 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21601 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21602
21603 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21604 5 seconds ("c----").
21605
21606 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21607 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021608 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021609
21610 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021611 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021612 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21613 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21614 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21615 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21616 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021617
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021618
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200216199. Supported filters
21620--------------------
21621
21622Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21623accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21624unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21625
21626See also : "filter"
21627
216289.1. Trace
21629----------
21630
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021631filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021632
21633 Arguments:
21634 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21635 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21636
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021637 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021638
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021639 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021640 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21641 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21642 amount of the parsed data.
21643
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021644 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021645
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021646This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21647callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21648information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21649filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21650
21651Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21652tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21653a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21654
21655
216569.2. HTTP compression
21657---------------------
21658
21659filter compression
21660
21661The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21662keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021663when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21664fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21665done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21666explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21667filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21668listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21669order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021670
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021671See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21672 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021673
21674
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216759.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21676--------------------------------------------
21677
21678filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21679
21680 Arguments :
21681
21682 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21683 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21684 parsed.
21685
21686 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21687 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21688 part must be placed in its own scope.
21689
21690The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21691external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021692streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021693exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21694also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21695
21696SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21697the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21698
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021699For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021700"doc/SPOE.txt".
21701
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100217029.4. Cache
21703----------
21704
21705filter cache <name>
21706
21707 Arguments :
21708
21709 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21710
21711The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21712"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021713cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021714other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21715case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21716is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21717filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021718listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21719order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021720
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021721See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21722 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21723
21724
217259.5. Fcgi-app
21726-------------
21727
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021728filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021729
21730 Arguments :
21731
21732 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21733
21734The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21735request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21736reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21737used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21738implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21739used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21740fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21741used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21742order.
21743
21744See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21745 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21746
21747
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217489.6. OpenTracing
21749----------------
21750
21751The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21752HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21753of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21754Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21755
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021756This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021757
21758The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21759HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21760participates in the work of HAProxy.
21761
21762filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21763
21764 Arguments :
21765
21766 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21767 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21768 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21769 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21770 OpenTracing filters.
21771
21772 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21773 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21774 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21775 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21776 filter must have its own scope defined.
21777
21778More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021779of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021780
21781
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002178210. FastCGI applications
21783-------------------------
21784
21785HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21786feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21787the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21788FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21789servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21790FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21791backend.
21792
21793HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21794application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21795connection.
21796
2179710.1. Setup
21798-----------
21799
2180010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21801--------------------------
21802
21803fcgi-app <name>
21804 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21805 document root must be defined.
21806
21807acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21808 Declare or complete an access list.
21809
21810 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21811 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21812 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21813 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21814 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21815
21816docroot <path>
21817 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21818 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21819 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21820
21821index <script-name>
21822 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21823 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21824 is an optional setting.
21825
21826 Example :
21827 index index.php
21828
21829log-stderr global
21830log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021831 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021832 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21833
21834 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21835 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21836
21837pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21838 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21839 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21840 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21841
21842 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21843 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21844 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21845 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21846
21847 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21848 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21849
21850path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021851 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021852 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21853 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21854 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21855 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21856 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21857 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21858 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021859
21860 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021861 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021862 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21863 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21864 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21865 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021866
21867 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021868 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21869 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021870
21871option get-values
21872no option get-values
21873 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21874
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021875 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021876 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21877
21878 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21879 application will accept.
21880
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021881 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21882 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021883
21884 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021885 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021886 option is disabled.
21887
21888 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21889 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21890 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21891 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21892 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21893 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21894
21895option keep-conn
21896no option keep-conn
21897 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21898 sending a response.
21899
21900 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21901 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21902
21903option max-reqs <reqs>
21904 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21905 accept.
21906
21907 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21908 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21909 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21910 to 1.
21911
21912option mpxs-conns
21913no option mpxs-conns
21914 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21915
21916 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21917 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21918
21919set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21920 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21921 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21922 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21923 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21924
21925 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21926 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21927 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21928
21929 Example :
21930 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21931 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21932
21933 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21934
21935
2193610.1.2. Proxy section
21937---------------------
21938
21939use-fcgi-app <name>
21940 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21941
21942 Arguments :
21943 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21944
21945 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21946 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21947 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21948 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21949 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21950
21951 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21952 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21953 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21954 application are evaluated.
21955
21956
2195710.1.3. Example
21958---------------
21959
21960 frontend front-http
21961 mode http
21962 bind *:80
21963 bind *:
21964
21965 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21966 default_backend back-static
21967
21968 backend back-static
21969 mode http
21970 server www A.B.C.D:80
21971
21972 backend back-dynamic
21973 mode http
21974 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21975 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21976
21977 fcgi-app php-fpm
21978 log-stderr global
21979 option keep-conn
21980
21981 docroot /var/www/my-app
21982 index index.php
21983 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21984
21985
2198610.2. Default parameters
21987------------------------
21988
21989A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21990the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021991script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021992applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21993
21994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21995 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21996 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21997 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21998 | | |
21999 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22000 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22001 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22002 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22003 | | application. |
22004 | | |
22005 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22006 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22007 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22008 | | |
22009 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22010 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22011 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22012 | | the application's configuration. |
22013 | | |
22014 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22015 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22016 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22017 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22018 | | |
22019 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22020 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22021 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22022 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22023 | | be defined. |
22024 | | |
22025 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22026 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22027 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22028 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22029 | | is not set too. |
22030 | | |
22031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22032 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22033 | | set. |
22034 | | |
22035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22036 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22037 | | the request. |
22038 | | |
22039 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22040 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22041 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22042 | | |
22043 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22044 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22045 | | script to process the request. |
22046 | | |
22047 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22048 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22049 | | |
22050 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22051 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22052 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22053 | | |
22054 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22055 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22056 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22057 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22058 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22059 | | |
22060 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22061 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22062 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22063 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22064 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22065 | | side. |
22066 | | |
22067 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22068 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22069 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22070 | | connected to. |
22071 | | |
22072 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22073 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22074 | | |
22075 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022076 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22077 | | current HAProxy version. |
22078 | | |
22079 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022080 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22081 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22082 | | |
22083 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22084
22085
2208610.3. Limitations
22087------------------
22088
22089The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22090way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22091during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22092establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22093application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22094or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22095message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22096these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22097and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22098
22099Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22100request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22101requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22102
22103About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22104into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22105fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22106"http-request" ones.
22107
22108Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22109FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22110processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22111must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22112here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022113
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022114
2211511. Address formats
22116-------------------
22117
22118Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22119address.
22120
22121This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22122The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22123of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22124equivalent is '::'.
22125
22126Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22127is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22128
22129This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22130family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22131
22132Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22133configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22134use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22135'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22136
22137Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22138socket type and the transport method.
22139
22140
2214111.1 Address family prefixes
22142----------------------------
22143
22144'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22145
22146'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22147 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22148 listening.
22149
22150'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22151 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22152 on the statement using this address, a port or
22153 a port range may or must be specified.
22154
22155'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22156 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22157 using this address, a port or a port range
22158 may or must be specified.
22159
22160'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22161 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22162 using this address, a port or a port range
22163 may or must be specified.
22164
22165'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22166 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22167 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22168 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22169 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22170 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22171
22172'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22173 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22174 start by slash '/'.
22175
22176
2217711.2 Socket type prefixes
22178-------------------------
22179
22180Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22181type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22182this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22183This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22184but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22185
22186Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22187instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22188
22189If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22190they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22191report this to the maintainers.
22192
22193'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22194 to "stream"
22195
22196'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22197 to "datagram".
22198
22199
2220011.3 Protocol prefixes
22201----------------------
22202
22203'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22204 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22205 socket type and transport method is forced to
22206 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22207 this address, a port or a port range can or
22208 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22209 of 'stream+ip@'.
22210
22211'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22212 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22213 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22214 statement using this address, a port or port
22215 range can or must be specified.
22216 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22217
22218'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22219 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22220 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22221 statement using this address, a port or port
22222 range can or must be specified.
22223 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22224
22225'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22226 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22227 socket type and transport method is forced to
22228 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22229 this address, a port or a port range can or
22230 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22231 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22232
22233'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22234 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22235 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22236 the statement using this address, a port or
22237 port range can or must be specified.
22238 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22239
22240'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22241 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22242 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22243 the statement using this address, a port or
22244 port range can or must be specified.
22245 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22246
22247'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22248 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22249 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22250
22251'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22252 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22253 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22254
22255In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22256QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022258/*
22259 * Local variables:
22260 * fill-column: 79
22261 * End:
22262 */